blob: 149c0c860743b0d5ab9a63bf3cd4bad17262a268 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau16216822012-09-10 09:46:55 +02007 2012/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100565. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
586. HTTP header manipulation
59
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100607. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200617.1. Matching integers
627.2. Matching strings
637.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200647.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200657.5. Available matching criteria
667.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
677.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
687.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
697.6. Pre-defined ACLs
707.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100717.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072
738. Logging
748.1. Log levels
758.2. Log formats
768.2.1. Default log format
778.2.2. TCP log format
788.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100798.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200808.3. Advanced logging options
818.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
828.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
838.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
848.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
858.4. Timing events
868.5. Session state at disconnection
878.6. Non-printable characters
888.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
908.9. Examples of logs
91
929. Statistics and monitoring
939.1. CSV format
949.2. Unix Socket commands
95
96
971. Quick reminder about HTTP
98----------------------------
99
100When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
101fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
102on almost anything found in the contents.
103
104However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
105formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
106correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
107
108
1091.1. The HTTP transaction model
110-------------------------------
111
112The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100113to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
115connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
116will involve a new connection :
117
118 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
119
120In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
121establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
122by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
123length.
124
125Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
126to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
127however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
128response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
129header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
130
131 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
132
133Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
134power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
135but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200136a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
138A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
139keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
140second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
141page :
142
143 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
144
145This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
146latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
147correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
148the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100149server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
152connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
153everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
154established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
155sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
156while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
157another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
158sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
159http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
160mode.
161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162
1631.2. HTTP request
164-----------------
165
166First, let's consider this HTTP request :
167
168 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100169 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
171 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
172 3 User-agent: my small browser
173 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
174 5 Accept: image/png
175
176
1771.2.1. The Request line
178-----------------------
179
180Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
181
182 - a METHOD : GET
183 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
184 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
185
186All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
187which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
188followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
189is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
190desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
191the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
192
193The URI itself can have several forms :
194
195 - A "relative URI" :
196
197 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
198
199 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
200 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
201
202 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
203
204 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
207 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
208 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
209 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
210 must accept this form too.
211
212 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
213 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
214 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
217 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
218 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
219 other protocols too.
220
221In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
222mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
223on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
224It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
225specific to the language, framework or application in use.
226
227
2281.2.2. The request headers
229--------------------------
230
231The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
232beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
233an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
234Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
235values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
236encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
237the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
238define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
239
240Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
241their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
242"Connection:" header).
243
244The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
245that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
246is one valid form of empty line.
247
248Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
249headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
250about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
251application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
252
253Important note:
254 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
255 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
256 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
257 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
258
259
2601.3. HTTP response
261------------------
262
263An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
264messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
265
266 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100267 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200268 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
269 2 Content-length: 350
270 3 Content-Type: text/html
271
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200272As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
273codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
274response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100275continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
276the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
277following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
278sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
279(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
280correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
281such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
282state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
283over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
284if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
285information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.3.1. The Response line
289------------------------
290
291Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
292
293 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
294 - a status code : 200
295 - a reason : OK
296
297The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
300 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
301 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
302 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
303
304Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100305"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
307messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
308or "Authentication Required".
309
310Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
311
312 Code When / reason
313 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
314 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
316 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 400 for an invalid or too large request
318 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
319 accessing the stats page)
320 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
321 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
322 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
323 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
324 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
325 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
326 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
327 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
328 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
329
330The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3314.2).
332
333
3341.3.2. The response headers
335---------------------------
336
337Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
338the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
339details.
340
341
3422. Configuring HAProxy
343----------------------
344
3452.1. Configuration file format
346------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200347
348HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
349
350 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
351 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
352 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
353 "frontend" and "backend".
354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100355The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
356referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
357delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100358preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100359escaped by doubling them.
360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
3622.2. Time format
363----------------
364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100365Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100366values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
367otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
368numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
369for every keyword. Supported units are :
370
371 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
372 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
373 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
374 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
375 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
376 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
377
378
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003792.3. Examples
380-------------
381
382 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
383 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
384 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
385 global
386 daemon
387 maxconn 256
388
389 defaults
390 mode http
391 timeout connect 5000ms
392 timeout client 50000ms
393 timeout server 50000ms
394
395 frontend http-in
396 bind *:80
397 default_backend servers
398
399 backend servers
400 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
401
402
403 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
404 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
405 global
406 daemon
407 maxconn 256
408
409 defaults
410 mode http
411 timeout connect 5000ms
412 timeout client 50000ms
413 timeout server 50000ms
414
415 listen http-in
416 bind *:80
417 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
418
419
420Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
421
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100422 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200423
424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004253. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200426--------------------
427
428Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
429are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
430of them have command-line equivalents.
431
432The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
433
434 * Process management and security
435 - chroot
436 - daemon
437 - gid
438 - group
439 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100440 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - nbproc
442 - pidfile
443 - uid
444 - ulimit-n
445 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200446 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200447 - node
448 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100449 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100450
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200451 * Performance tuning
452 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200453 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100454 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200455 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - noepoll
457 - nokqueue
458 - nopoll
459 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100460 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200461 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200462 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200463 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200464 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100465 - tune.maxaccept
466 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200467 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200468 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100469 - tune.rcvbuf.client
470 - tune.rcvbuf.server
471 - tune.sndbuf.client
472 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100473
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474 * Debugging
475 - debug
476 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477
478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004793.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200480------------------------------------
481
482chroot <jail dir>
483 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
484 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
485 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
486 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
487 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
488 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100489
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200490daemon
491 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
492 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
493 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
494
495gid <number>
496 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
497 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
498 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
499 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100500
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200501group <group name>
502 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
503 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200505log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
507 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100508 configured with "log global".
509
510 <address> can be one of:
511
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100512 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100513 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
514 port).
515
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100516 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
517 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
518 port).
519
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100520 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
521 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
522 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
523 writeable).
524
525 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526
527 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
528 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
529 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
530
531 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200532 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
533 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
534 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
535 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
536 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
537 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200538
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200539 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100541log-send-hostname [<string>]
542 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
543 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
544 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
545 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
546 the logs.
547
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000548log-tag <string>
549 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
550 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
551 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
552 running on the same host.
553
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554nbproc <number>
555 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
556 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
557 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
558 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
559 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
560
561pidfile <pidfile>
562 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
563 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
564 starting the process. See also "daemon".
565
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200566stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
567 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
568 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
569 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
570 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200571
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200572 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
573 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
574 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200575
576stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
577 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
578 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100579 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200580
581stats maxconn <connections>
582 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
583 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
584
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585uid <number>
586 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
587 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
588 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
589 one. See also "gid" and "user".
590
591ulimit-n <number>
592 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
593 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
594 option.
595
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100596unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
597 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
598
599 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
600 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
601 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
602 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
603 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
604 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
605 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
606 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
607 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
608 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
609
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610user <user name>
611 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
612 See also "uid" and "group".
613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200614node <name>
615 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
616
617 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
618 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
619 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
620 traffic.
621
622description <text>
623 Add a text that describes the instance.
624
625 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
626 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
627 "<" and ">" characters.
628
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200629
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006303.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200631-----------------------
632
633maxconn <number>
634 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
635 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
636 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
637 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
638
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200639maxconnrate <number>
640 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
641 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
642 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
643 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
644 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
645 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
646 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
647 fairness.
648
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649maxpipes <number>
650 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
651 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
652 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
653 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
654 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
655 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
656
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200657maxsslconn <number>
658 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
659 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
660 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
661 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
662 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
663 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
664 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
665
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200666noepoll
667 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
668 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
669 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
670
671nokqueue
672 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
673 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
674 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
675
676nopoll
677 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
678 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100679 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200680 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
681 "nokqueue".
682
683nosepoll
684 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
685 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
686 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
687
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100688nosplice
689 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
690 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
691 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100692 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100693 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
694 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
695 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
696 "option splice-response".
697
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200698spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
699 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
700 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
701 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
702 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
703 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
704
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200705tune.bufsize <number>
706 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
707 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
708 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
709 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
710 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
711 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
712 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
713 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
714
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200715tune.chksize <number>
716 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
717 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
718 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
719 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
720 checks whenever possible.
721
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200722tune.http.maxhdr <number>
723 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
724 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
725 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
726 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
727 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
728 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
729 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
730 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
731 limit too high.
732
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100733tune.maxaccept <number>
734 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
735 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
736 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100737 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100738 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
739 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100740 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100741 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
742
743tune.maxpollevents <number>
744 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
745 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
746 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
747 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
748 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
749
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200750tune.maxrewrite <number>
751 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
752 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
753 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
754 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
755 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
756 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
757 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
758 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
759 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
760 bufsize.
761
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200762tune.pipesize <number>
763 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
764 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
765 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
766 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
767 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
768 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
769
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100770tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
771tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
772 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
773 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
774 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
775 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
776 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
777 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
778 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
779
780tune.sndbuf.client <number>
781tune.sndbuf.server <number>
782 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
783 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
784 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
785 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
786 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
787 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
788 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
789 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
790 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
791 notifying haproxy again.
792
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007943.3. Debugging
795--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200796
797debug
798 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
799 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
800 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
801 system startup.
802
803quiet
804 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
805 line argument "-q".
806
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200807
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008083.4. Userlists
809--------------
810It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
811http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
812it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
813
814userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100815 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100816 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
817
818group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100819 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100820 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
821 proceeded by "users" keyword.
822
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100823user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
824 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100825 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
826 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100827 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
828 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100829 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
830 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
831
832
833 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100834 userlist L1
835 group G1 users tiger,scott
836 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100837
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100838 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
839 user scott insecure-password elgato
840 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100841
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100842 userlist L2
843 group G1
844 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100845
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100846 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
847 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
848 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100849
850 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200851
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200852
8533.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200854----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200855It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
856haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
857pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
858identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
859or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
860Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
861known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
862the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
863process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
864during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
865tables.
866
867peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400868 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200869 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
870
871peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
872 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
873 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
874 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
875 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
876 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
877 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
878
879 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
880 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
881
882 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
883 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
884 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
885 across all peers.
886
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200887 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200888 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100889 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
890 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
891 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200892
893 backend mybackend
894 mode tcp
895 balance roundrobin
896 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
897 stick on src
898
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100899 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
900 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200901
902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009034. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200904----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100905
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200906Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
907 - defaults <name>
908 - frontend <name>
909 - backend <name>
910 - listen <name>
911
912A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
913its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
914section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100915section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200916
917A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
918connections.
919
920A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
921to forward incoming connections.
922
923A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
924parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
925
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100926All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
927'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
928case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
929
930Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
931logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
932proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
933However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
934name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
935
936Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
937and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100938bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100939protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
940modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
941arbitrary criteria.
942
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009444.1. Proxy keywords matrix
945--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200947The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
948limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
949they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
950limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100951marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200952option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200953and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
954with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
955specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100956
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200957
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100958 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
959------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
960acl - X X X
961appsession - - X X
962backlog X X X -
963balance X - X X
964bind - X X -
965bind-process X X X X
966block - X X X
967capture cookie - X X -
968capture request header - X X -
969capture response header - X X -
970clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
971contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
972cookie X - X X
973default-server X - X X
974default_backend X X X -
975description - X X X
976disabled X X X X
977dispatch - - X X
978enabled X X X X
979errorfile X X X X
980errorloc X X X X
981errorloc302 X X X X
982-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
983errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200984force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100985fullconn X - X X
986grace X X X X
987hash-type X - X X
988http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100989http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200990http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100991http-request - X X X
992id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200993ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +0200994log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100995maxconn X X X -
996mode X X X X
997monitor fail - X X -
998monitor-net X X X -
999monitor-uri X X X -
1000option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1001option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1002option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1003option allbackups (*) X - X X
1004option checkcache (*) X - X X
1005option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1006option contstats (*) X X X -
1007option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1008option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1009option forceclose (*) X X X X
1010-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1011option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001012option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001013option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001014option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1015option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1016option httpchk X - X X
1017option httpclose (*) X X X X
1018option httplog X X X X
1019option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001020option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001021option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001022option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1023option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1024option logasap (*) X X X -
1025option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001026option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001027option nolinger (*) X X X X
1028option originalto X X X X
1029option persist (*) X - X X
1030option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001031option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001032option smtpchk X - X X
1033option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1034option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1035option splice-request (*) X X X X
1036option splice-response (*) X X X X
1037option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1038option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1039-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1040option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1041option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1042option tcpka X X X X
1043option tcplog X X X X
1044option transparent (*) X - X X
1045persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1046rate-limit sessions X X X -
1047redirect - X X X
1048redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1049redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1050reqadd - X X X
1051reqallow - X X X
1052reqdel - X X X
1053reqdeny - X X X
1054reqiallow - X X X
1055reqidel - X X X
1056reqideny - X X X
1057reqipass - X X X
1058reqirep - X X X
1059reqisetbe - X X X
1060reqitarpit - X X X
1061reqpass - X X X
1062reqrep - X X X
1063-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1064reqsetbe - X X X
1065reqtarpit - X X X
1066retries X - X X
1067rspadd - X X X
1068rspdel - X X X
1069rspdeny - X X X
1070rspidel - X X X
1071rspideny - X X X
1072rspirep - X X X
1073rsprep - X X X
1074server - - X X
1075source X - X X
1076srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001077stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001078stats auth X - X X
1079stats enable X - X X
1080stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001081stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001082stats realm X - X X
1083stats refresh X - X X
1084stats scope X - X X
1085stats show-desc X - X X
1086stats show-legends X - X X
1087stats show-node X - X X
1088stats uri X - X X
1089-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1090stick match - - X X
1091stick on - - X X
1092stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001093stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001094stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001095tcp-request connection - X X -
1096tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001097tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001098tcp-response content - - X X
1099tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001100timeout check X - X X
1101timeout client X X X -
1102timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1103timeout connect X - X X
1104timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1105timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1106timeout http-request X X X X
1107timeout queue X - X X
1108timeout server X - X X
1109timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1110timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001111timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001112transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001113unique-id-format X X X -
1114unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001115use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001116use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001117------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1118 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001119
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011214.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1122---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001123
1124This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1125
1126
1127acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1128 Declare or complete an access list.
1129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1130 no | yes | yes | yes
1131 Example:
1132 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1133 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1134 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1135
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001136 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001137
1138
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001139appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1140 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001141 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1143 no | no | yes | yes
1144 Arguments :
1145 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1146 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1147
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001148 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001149 checked in each cookie value.
1150
1151 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1152 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1153 milliseconds.
1154
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001155 request-learn
1156 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1157 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1158 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1159 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1160 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1161 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1162
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001163 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1164 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1165 data following this prefix.
1166
1167 Example :
1168 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1169
1170 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1171 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1172
1173 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1174 2 modes are currently supported :
1175 - path-parameters :
1176 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1177 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1178 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1179 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1180 - query-string :
1181 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1182 query string.
1183
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001184 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1185 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1186 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1187 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001188 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1189 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1190 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001191 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1192 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1193
1194 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1195
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001196 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1197 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1198 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1199
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001200 Example :
1201 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1202
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001203 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1204 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001205
1206
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001207backlog <conns>
1208 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1210 yes | yes | yes | no
1211 Arguments :
1212 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1213 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001214 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001215
1216 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1217 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1218 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1219 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1220 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1221 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1222 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1223 backlog parameter.
1224
1225 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1226 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1227 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1228
1229 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1230
1231
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001233balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001234 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1236 yes | no | yes | yes
1237 Arguments :
1238 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1239 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1240 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1241 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1242
1243 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1244 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1245 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1246 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001247 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1248 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1249 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1250 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1251 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1252 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1253 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1254 it, so that you don't worry.
1255
1256 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1257 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1258 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1259 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1260 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1261 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1262 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1263 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001264
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001265 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1266 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1267 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1268 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1269 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1270 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1271 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1272 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1273
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001274 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1275 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1276 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1277 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001278 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001279 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1280 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1281 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1282 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1283 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001284 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1285 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1286 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1287 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1288 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1289 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001290
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001291 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1292 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1293 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1294 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1295 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1296 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1297 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1298 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001299 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001300 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001301 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1302 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1303 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001304
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001305 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1306 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1307 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1308 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1309 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1310 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1311 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1312 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1313 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1314 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1315 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1316 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001317
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001318 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001319 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1320 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1321 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1322 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1323 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1324 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1325 URIs start with a leading "/".
1326
1327 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1328 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1329 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1330 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1331
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001332 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001333 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1334
1335 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001336 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1337 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1338 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1339 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1340 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1341 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1342 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1343 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1344 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1345 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1346 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1347 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1348 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1349 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1350 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1351 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1352 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1353 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1354 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001355
1356 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1357 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1358 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1359 server will receive the request.
1360
1361 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1362 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1363 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1364 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1365 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001366 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1367 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1368 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001369
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001370 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1371 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1372 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1373 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1374 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001376 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001377 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1378 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1379 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1380
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001381 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1382 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1383 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1384
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001385 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001386 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001387 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1388 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1389 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1390 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1391 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1392 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001393 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001394 used instead.
1395
1396 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1397 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1398 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1399 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1400
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001401 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1402 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1403 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1404
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001405 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001406
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001407 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001408 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1409 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001410
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001411 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001412 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001413
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001414 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1415 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1416 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001417
1418 Examples :
1419 balance roundrobin
1420 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001421 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001422 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1423 balance hdr(host)
1424 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001425
1426 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1427 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1428
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001429 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001430 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1431 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1432 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1433 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1434
1435 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1436 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1437 defaults to 16 kB.
1438
1439 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1440 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1441
1442 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1443 Round Robin.
1444
1445 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1446 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1447 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1448 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1449
1450 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1451
1452 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001453 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001454 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1455 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1456 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001457
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001458 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1459 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001460
1461
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001462bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1463bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001464 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1466 no | yes | yes | no
1467 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001468 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1469 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1470 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1471 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001472 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001473
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001474 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1475 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001476 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1477 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1478 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001479 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1480 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1481 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1482 the range.
1483
1484 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1485 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1486 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1487 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1488 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1489 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1490 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001491 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001492 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001493
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001494 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1495 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1496 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1497 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1498 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1499 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1500 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1501 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1502
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001503 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1504 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1505 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1506 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001507
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001508 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1509 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1510 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1511 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1512 in a frontend.
1513
1514 Example :
1515 listen http_proxy
1516 bind :80,:443
1517 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001518 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001519
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001520 listen http_https_proxy
1521 bind :80
1522 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem prefer-server-ciphers
1523
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001524 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001525 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001526
1527
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001528bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1529 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1531 yes | yes | yes | yes
1532 Arguments :
1533 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1534 may be used to override a default value.
1535
1536 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1537 option may be combined with other numbers.
1538
1539 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1540 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1541 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1542 missing from all processes.
1543
1544 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1545 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1546 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1547 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1548
1549 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1550 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1551 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1552 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1553 and 'even' instances.
1554
1555 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1556 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1557 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1558 32.
1559
1560 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1561 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1562
1563 Example :
1564 listen app_ip1
1565 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001566 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001567
1568 listen app_ip2
1569 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001570 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001571
1572 listen management
1573 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001574 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001575
1576 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1577
1578
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001579block { if | unless } <condition>
1580 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1582 no | yes | yes | yes
1583
1584 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1585 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001586 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001587 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001588 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1589 "block" statements per instance.
1590
1591 Example:
1592 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1593 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1594 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1595 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1596
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001597 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001598
1599
1600capture cookie <name> len <length>
1601 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1603 no | yes | yes | no
1604 Arguments :
1605 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1606 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1607 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1608 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1609 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1610
1611 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1612 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1613 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1614 right if it exceeds <length>.
1615
1616 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1617 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1618 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1619 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1620
1621 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1622 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1623 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1624
1625 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1626 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1627 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1628 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001629 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001630 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1631
1632 Example:
1633 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1634
1635 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001636 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001637
1638
1639capture request header <name> len <length>
1640 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1642 no | yes | yes | no
1643 Arguments :
1644 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001645 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001646 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1647 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1648 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1649
1650 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1651 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1652 it exceeds <length>.
1653
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001654 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001655 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1656 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001657 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1658 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1659 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1660 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001661 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001662 environments to find where the request came from.
1663
1664 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1665 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1666 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1667 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001668
1669 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1670 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1671 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1672 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1673
1674 Example:
1675 capture request header Host len 15
1676 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1677 capture request header Referrer len 15
1678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001679 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001680 about logging.
1681
1682
1683capture response header <name> len <length>
1684 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1686 no | yes | yes | no
1687 Arguments :
1688 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001689 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001690 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1691 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1692 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1693
1694 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1695 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1696 it exceeds <length>.
1697
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001698 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001699 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1700 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1701 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001702 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1703 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1704 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1705 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001706
1707 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1708 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1709 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1710 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1711
1712 Example:
1713 capture response header Content-length len 9
1714 capture response header Location len 15
1715
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001716 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001717 about logging.
1718
1719
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001720clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001721 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1723 yes | yes | yes | no
1724 Arguments :
1725 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1726 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1727 as explained at the top of this document.
1728
1729 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1730 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1731 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1732 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1733 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1734 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1735 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1736 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001737 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001738 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1739 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1740
1741 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1742 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1743 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1744 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1745 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1746 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1747
1748 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1749 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1750
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001751 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1752 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001753
1754
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001755contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001756 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1758 yes | no | yes | yes
1759 Arguments :
1760 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1761 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1762 as explained at the top of this document.
1763
1764 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001765 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001766 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001767 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1768 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1769 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1770 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1771
1772 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1773 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1774 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1775 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1776 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1777 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1778
1779 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1780 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1781 instead.
1782
1783 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1784 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1785
1786
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001787cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001788 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1789 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001790 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1792 yes | no | yes | yes
1793 Arguments :
1794 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1795 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1796 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1797 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1798 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1799 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1800 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1801 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1802 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1803
1804 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1805 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1806 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1807 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1808 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1809 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1810 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1811 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1812 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1813 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1814 "insert" and "prefix".
1815
1816 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001817 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001818
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001819 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001820 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1821 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1822 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1823 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1824 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1825 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1826 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1827 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1828 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1829 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001830
1831 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1832 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1833 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1834 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1835 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1836 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1837 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1838 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1839 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1840 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001841 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1842 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1843 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001844
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001845 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1846 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1847 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001848 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1849 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1850 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1851 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001852 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1853 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1854 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001855
1856 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1857 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1858 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1859 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1860 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1861 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1862 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1863 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1864 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1865
1866 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1867 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1868 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1869 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1870 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1871 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1872 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1873 persistence cookie in the cache.
1874 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1875
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001876 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1877 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1878 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1879 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1880 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1881 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1882 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1883 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1884 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1885 they logout.
1886
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001887 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
1888 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
1889 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
1890 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
1891
1892 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
1893 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
1894 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
1895 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
1896 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
1897 this attribute.
1898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001899 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001900 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001901 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1902 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1903 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1904 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1905 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1906 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001907
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001908 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1909 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1910 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1911 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1912 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1913 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1914 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1915 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1916 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1917 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1918 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1919 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1920 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1921 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1922 the site.
1923
1924 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1925 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1926 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1927 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1928 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1929 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1930 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1931 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1932 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1933 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1934 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1935 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1936 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1937 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1938 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1939 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1940
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001941 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1942 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1943 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1944 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001945
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001946 Examples :
1947 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1948 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1949 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001950 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001951
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001952 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001953 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001954
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001956default-server [param*]
1957 Change default options for a server in a backend
1958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1959 yes | no | yes | yes
1960 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001961 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1962 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1963 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1964 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001965
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001966 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001967 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1968
1969 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001970
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001971
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001972default_backend <backend>
1973 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
1974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1975 yes | yes | yes | no
1976 Arguments :
1977 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
1978
1979 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
1980 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
1981 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
1982 will catch all undetermined requests.
1983
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001984 Example :
1985
1986 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
1987 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
1988 default_backend dynamic
1989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001990 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
1991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001992
1993disabled
1994 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1996 yes | yes | yes | yes
1997 Arguments : none
1998
1999 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2000 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2001 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2002 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2003 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2004 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2005 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2006
2007 See also : "enabled"
2008
2009
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002010dispatch <address>:<port>
2011 Set a default server address
2012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2013 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002014 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002015
2016 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2017 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2018 during start-up.
2019
2020 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2021 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2022 possible with normal servers.
2023
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002024 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002025 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2026 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2027 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2028 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2029
2030 See also : "server"
2031
2032
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002033enabled
2034 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2036 yes | yes | yes | yes
2037 Arguments : none
2038
2039 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2040 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2041
2042 See also : "disabled"
2043
2044
2045errorfile <code> <file>
2046 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2048 yes | yes | yes | yes
2049 Arguments :
2050 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002051 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052
2053 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002054 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002055 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002056 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2057 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002058
2059 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2060 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2061 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2062
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002063 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002065 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2066 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2067 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2068 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2069
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002070 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2071 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2072 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2073 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2074 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2075 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2076
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002077 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2078 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2079 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002080 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002081 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2082
2083 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2084
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002085 Example :
2086 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2087 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2088 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2089
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002090
2091errorloc <code> <url>
2092errorloc302 <code> <url>
2093 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2095 yes | yes | yes | yes
2096 Arguments :
2097 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002098 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002099
2100 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2101 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2102 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2103 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2104 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2105
2106 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2107 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2108 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2109
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002110 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2111
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002112 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2113 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2114 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2115 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2116 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2117 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2118 request.
2119
2120 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2121
2122
2123errorloc303 <code> <url>
2124 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2126 yes | yes | yes | yes
2127 Arguments :
2128 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2129 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2130
2131 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2132 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2133 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2134 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2135 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2136
2137 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2138 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2139 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2140
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002141 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2142
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002143 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2144 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2145 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2146 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002147 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002148
2149 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2150
2151
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002152force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2153 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2154 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2155 no | yes | yes | yes
2156
2157 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2158 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2159 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2160 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2161 marked down for maintenance operations.
2162
2163 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2164 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2165 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2166 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2167 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2168 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2169 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2170 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2171 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2172
2173 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2174 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2175 is used.
2176
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002177 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002178 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002179
2180
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002181fullconn <conns>
2182 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2184 yes | no | yes | yes
2185 Arguments :
2186 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2187 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2188
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002189 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002190 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002191 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002192 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2193 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2194 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2195 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2196 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002197 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002198
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002199 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2200 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2201 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2202
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002203 Example :
2204 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2205 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2206 # connections.
2207 backend dynamic
2208 fullconn 10000
2209 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2210 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2211
2212 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2213
2214
2215grace <time>
2216 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002218 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002219 Arguments :
2220 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2221 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2222 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2223
2224 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2225 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002226 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002227 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2228
2229 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2230 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2231 simplify it.
2232
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002233
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002234hash-type <method>
2235 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2237 yes | no | yes | yes
2238 Arguments :
2239 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2240 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2241 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2242 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2243 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2244 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2245 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2246 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2247 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2248
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002249 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2250 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2251 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2252 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2253 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2254 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2255 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2256 this value.
2257
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002258 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2259 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2260 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2261 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2262 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2263 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2264 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2265 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2266 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2267 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2268 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2269 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2270 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2271
2272 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2273
2274 See also : "balance", "server"
2275
2276
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002277http-check disable-on-404
2278 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002280 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002281 Arguments : none
2282
2283 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2284 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2285 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2286 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2287 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2288 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2289 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2290 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002291 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2292 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2293 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2294
2295 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2296
2297
2298http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002299 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002301 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002302 Arguments :
2303 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2304 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002305 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002306 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2307 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2308 details on the supported keywords.
2309
2310 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2311 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2312 with the usual backslash ('\').
2313
2314 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2315 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2316 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2317 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2318 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2319
2320 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002321 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002322 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2323 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2324 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2325
2326 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002327 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002328 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2329 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2330 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2331 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2332
2333 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002334 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002335 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2336 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2337 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2338 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2339 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2340 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2341 trace).
2342
2343 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002344 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002345 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2346 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2347 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2348 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2349 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2350 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2351
2352 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2353 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2354 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2355 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2356 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2357 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2358 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2359 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2360
2361 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2362 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2363
2364 Examples :
2365 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002366 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002367
2368 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002369 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002370
2371 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002372 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002373
2374 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002375 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002376
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002377 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002378
2379
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002380http-check send-state
2381 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2383 yes | no | yes | yes
2384 Arguments : none
2385
2386 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2387 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2388 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2389 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2390 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2391
2392 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2393 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2394 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2395 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2396 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2397 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2398 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2399 checked in multiple backends.
2400
2401 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2402 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2403
2404 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2405 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2406 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2407 one fails.
2408
2409 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2410 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2411 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2412
2413 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2414 server's queue.
2415
2416 Example of a header received by the application server :
2417 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2418 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2419
2420 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2421
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002422http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002423 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002424 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2425
2426 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2427 no | yes | yes | yes
2428
2429 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2430 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2431 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002432 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2433 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002434 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2435
2436 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2437 instance.
2438
2439 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002440 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2441 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2442 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002443
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002444 http-request allow if nagios
2445 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2446 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2447 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002448
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002449 Example:
2450 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002451
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002452 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002453
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002454 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2455 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002456
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002457http-send-name-header [<header>]
2458 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2459
2460 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2461 yes | no | yes | yes
2462
2463 Arguments :
2464
2465 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2466
2467 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2468 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2469 is added with the header string proved.
2470
2471 See also : "server"
2472
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002473id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002474 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2476 no | yes | yes | yes
2477 Arguments : none
2478
2479 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2480 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2481 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002482
2483
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002484ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2485 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2486 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2487 no | yes | yes | yes
2488
2489 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2490 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2491 and running).
2492
2493 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2494 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2495 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2496 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2497 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2498
2499 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2500 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2501
2502 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2503 "unless" condition is met.
2504
2505 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2506
2507
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002508log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002509log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002510no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002511 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2513 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002514
2515 Prefix :
2516 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2517 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2518 prefix does not allow arguments.
2519
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002520 Arguments :
2521 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2522 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2523 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2524 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2525 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2526 parameter.
2527
2528 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2529 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2530
2531 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2532 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2533 standard syslog port).
2534
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002535 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2536 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2537 standard syslog port).
2538
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002539 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2540 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2541 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2542 appropriately writeable).
2543
2544 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2545
2546 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2547 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2548 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2549
2550 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2551 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2552 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002553 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2554 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2555 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2556 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2557 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002558
2559 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2560
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002561 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2562 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2563 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002564
2565 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2566 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2567 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2568 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2569
2570 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2571 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002572
2573 Example :
2574 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002575 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2576 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002577
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002578log-format <string>
2579 Allows you to custom a log line.
2580
2581 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2582
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002583
2584maxconn <conns>
2585 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2587 yes | yes | yes | no
2588 Arguments :
2589 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2590 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2591 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2592 closes.
2593
2594 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2595 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2596 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2597 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2598 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2599 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2600 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2601 properly tuned.
2602
2603 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2604 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2605 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2606
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002607 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2608
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002609 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2610
2611
2612mode { tcp|http|health }
2613 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2615 yes | yes | yes | yes
2616 Arguments :
2617 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2618 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2619 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2620 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2621
2622 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2623 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2624 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2625 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2626 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2627
2628 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2629 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2630 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2631 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2632 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2633 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2634
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002635 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2636 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2637 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002638
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002639 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002640 defaults http_instances
2641 mode http
2642
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002643 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002644
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002645
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002646monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002647 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2649 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002650 Arguments :
2651 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2652 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002653 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002654 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2655 backend and its backup.
2656
2657 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2658 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2659 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2660 servers in a list of backends.
2661
2662 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2663 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2664 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2665 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2666 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2667 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2668 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002669 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2670 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002671
2672 Example:
2673 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002674 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002675 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2676 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2677 monitor-uri /site_alive
2678 monitor fail if site_dead
2679
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002680 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002681
2682
2683monitor-net <source>
2684 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2686 yes | yes | yes | no
2687 Arguments :
2688 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2689 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2690 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2691 followed by a mask.
2692
2693 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2694 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002695 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002696 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2697
2698 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2699 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2700 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2701 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2702 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2703
2704 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2705 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2706 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2707 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2708 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2709
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002710 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2711 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002712
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002713 Example :
2714 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2715 frontend www
2716 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2717
2718 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2719
2720
2721monitor-uri <uri>
2722 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2724 yes | yes | yes | no
2725 Arguments :
2726 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2727 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2728
2729 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2730 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2731 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2732 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2733 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2734 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2735 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2736 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2737
2738 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2739 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2740 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2741 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2742 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2743 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2744
2745 Example :
2746 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2747 frontend www
2748 mode http
2749 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2750
2751 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2752
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002753
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002754option abortonclose
2755no option abortonclose
2756 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2758 yes | no | yes | yes
2759 Arguments : none
2760
2761 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2762 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2763 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2764 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002765 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002766 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2767 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2768 encountered while delivering the response.
2769
2770 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2771 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2772 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2773 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2774 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2775 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002776 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002777 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002778 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002779 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2780 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2781 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2782
2783 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2784 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2785 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2786 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2787 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2788 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2789 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2790 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002791 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002792
2793 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2794 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2795
2796 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2797
2798
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002799option accept-invalid-http-request
2800no option accept-invalid-http-request
2801 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2803 yes | yes | yes | no
2804 Arguments : none
2805
2806 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2807 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2808 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2809 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2810 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2811 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2812 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2813 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002814 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2815 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2816 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2817 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2818 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2819 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002820
2821 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2822 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2823 been confirmed.
2824
2825 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2826 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002827 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2828 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002829 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2830
2831 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2832 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2833
2834 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2835 stats socket.
2836
2837
2838option accept-invalid-http-response
2839no option accept-invalid-http-response
2840 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2842 yes | no | yes | yes
2843 Arguments : none
2844
2845 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2846 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2847 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2848 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2849 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2850 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2851 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2852 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2853 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2854
2855 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2856 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2857 been confirmed.
2858
2859 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2860 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2861 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2862 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2863
2864 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2865 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2866
2867 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2868 stats socket.
2869
2870
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002871option allbackups
2872no option allbackups
2873 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2875 yes | no | yes | yes
2876 Arguments : none
2877
2878 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2879 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2880 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2881 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2882 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2883 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2884 order between the backup servers anymore.
2885
2886 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2887 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2888
2889 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2890 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2891
2892
2893option checkcache
2894no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002895 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2897 yes | no | yes | yes
2898 Arguments : none
2899
2900 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2901 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002902 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002903 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2904 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002905 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002906
2907 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002908 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002909 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002910 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2911 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002912 to the client are :
2913 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002914 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002915 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002916 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2917 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2918 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2919 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2920 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2921 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2922 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2923 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2924 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2925 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2926 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2927
2928 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002929 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002930 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002931 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002932 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2933
2934 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2935 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002936 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002937 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2938
2939 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2940 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2941
2942
2943option clitcpka
2944no option clitcpka
2945 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2947 yes | yes | yes | no
2948 Arguments : none
2949
2950 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2951 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2952 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2953 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2954
2955 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2956 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2957 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2958 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2959
2960 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2961 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2962 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2963 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2964 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2965
2966 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2967
2968 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2969 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2970 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2971
2972 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2973 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2974
2975 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2976
2977
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002978option contstats
2979 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2981 yes | yes | yes | no
2982 Arguments : none
2983
2984 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2985 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2986 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2987 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2988 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2989 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2990 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2991
2992
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002993option dontlog-normal
2994no option dontlog-normal
2995 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2997 yes | yes | yes | no
2998 Arguments : none
2999
3000 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3001 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3002 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3003 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3004 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3005 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3006 logged.
3007
3008 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3009 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3010 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003012 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003013 logging.
3014
3015
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003016option dontlognull
3017no option dontlognull
3018 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3020 yes | yes | yes | no
3021 Arguments : none
3022
3023 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3024 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3025 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3026 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3027 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3028 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3029 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3030
3031 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3032 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3033 would not be logged.
3034
3035 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3036 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003038 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003039
3040
3041option forceclose
3042no option forceclose
3043 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003045 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003046 Arguments : none
3047
3048 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3049 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3050 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3051 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3052 global session times in the logs.
3053
3054 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003055 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003056 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3057 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3058 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3059 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003060
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003061 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3062 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3063 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3064
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003065 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3066 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3067
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003068 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003069
3070
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003071option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003072 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3074 yes | yes | yes | yes
3075 Arguments :
3076 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3077 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003078 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003079 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003080
3081 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3082 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3083 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3084 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3085 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3086 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3087 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003088 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3089 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3090 possible that the client has already brought one.
3091
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003092 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003093 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003094 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3095 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003096 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3097 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003098
3099 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3100 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3101 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3102 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3103 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3104 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3105 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3106
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003107 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3108 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3109 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3110 are under the control of the end-user.
3111
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003112 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003113 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3114 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003115 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3116 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3117 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003118
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003119 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3120 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3121 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3122 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3123 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003124
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003125 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003126 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3127 frontend www
3128 mode http
3129 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3130
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003131 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3132 backend www
3133 mode http
3134 option forwardfor header X-Client
3135
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003136 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3137 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003138
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003139
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003140option http-no-delay
3141no option http-no-delay
3142 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3144 yes | yes | yes | yes
3145 Arguments : none
3146
3147 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3148 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3149 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3150 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3151 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3152 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3153 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3154 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3155 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3156 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3157 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3158 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3159 affected.
3160
3161 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3162 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3163 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3164 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3165 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3166 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3167 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3168 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3169 latency environments.
3170
3171
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003172option http-pretend-keepalive
3173no option http-pretend-keepalive
3174 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3176 yes | yes | yes | yes
3177 Arguments : none
3178
3179 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3180 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3181 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3182 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3183 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3184 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3185 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3186 consider the response complete.
3187
3188 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3189 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3190 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3191 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3192 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3193 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3194
3195 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3196 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3197 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3198 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3199 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3200 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3201 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3202
3203 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3204 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003205 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003206 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3207 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003208
3209 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3210 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3211
3212 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3213
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003214
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003215option http-server-close
3216no option http-server-close
3217 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3219 yes | yes | yes | yes
3220 Arguments : none
3221
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003222 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3223 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3224 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3225 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3226 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3227 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3228 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3229 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3230 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3231 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3232 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3233 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003234
3235 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3236 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3237 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3238 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003239 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3240 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003241
3242 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3243 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003244 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3245 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3246 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003247
3248 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3249 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3250
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003251 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3252 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003253
3254
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003255option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003256no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003257 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3259 yes | yes | yes | no
3260 Arguments : none
3261
3262 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3263 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3264 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3265 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3266 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3267 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3268 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3269
3270 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3271 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3272 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3273 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3274 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3275 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3276 request along its whole life.
3277
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003278 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3279 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3280 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3281 front of an existing proxy.
3282
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003283 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3284
3285 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3286 http-server-close".
3287
3288
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003289option httpchk
3290option httpchk <uri>
3291option httpchk <method> <uri>
3292option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3293 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3295 yes | no | yes | yes
3296 Arguments :
3297 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3298 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3299 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3300 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3301 ones.
3302
3303 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3304 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3305 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3306
3307 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3308 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3309 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3310 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3311 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3312
3313 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3314 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3315 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3316 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3317 the lack of any response.
3318
3319 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3320
3321 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3322 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3323 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3324
3325 Examples :
3326 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3327 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3328 backend https_relay
3329 mode tcp
3330 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3331 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3332
3333 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003334 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3335 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003336
3337
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003338option httpclose
3339no option httpclose
3340 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3342 yes | yes | yes | yes
3343 Arguments : none
3344
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003345 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3346 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3347 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3348 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3349 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3350 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3351 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003352
3353 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003354 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003355 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3356 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3357 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3358 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3359 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003360
3361 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3362 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3363 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003364 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3365 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003366
3367 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3368 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3369
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003370 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3371 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003372
3373
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003374option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003375 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3377 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003378 Arguments :
3379 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3380 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3381 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3382 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3383 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003384
3385 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3386 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3387 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3388 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3389 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3390 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3391 ports.
3392
3393 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3394
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003395 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3396 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3397 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3398 by default.
3399
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003400 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003401
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003402
3403option http_proxy
3404no option http_proxy
3405 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3407 yes | yes | yes | yes
3408 Arguments : none
3409
3410 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3411 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3412 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3413 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3414 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3415
3416 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3417 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3418 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3419 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003420 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003421 be analyzed.
3422
3423 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3424 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3425
3426 Example :
3427 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3428 backend direct_forward
3429 option httpclose
3430 option http_proxy
3431
3432 See also : "option httpclose"
3433
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003434
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003435option independent-streams
3436no option independent-streams
3437 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3439 yes | yes | yes | yes
3440 Arguments : none
3441
3442 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3443 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3444 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3445 receive data or not.
3446
3447 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3448 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3449 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3450 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3451 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3452 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3453 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3454 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3455 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3456 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3457 socket buffers.
3458
3459 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3460 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3461 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3462 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3463 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3464
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003465 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3466 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3467 deprecated.
3468
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003469 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003470
3471
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003472option ldap-check
3473 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3475 yes | no | yes | yes
3476 Arguments : none
3477
3478 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3479 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3480 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3481 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3482
3483 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3484 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3485
3486 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3487 configure it.
3488
3489 Example :
3490 option ldap-check
3491
3492 See also : "option httpchk"
3493
3494
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003495option log-health-checks
3496no option log-health-checks
3497 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3499 yes | no | yes | yes
3500 Arguments : none
3501
3502 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3503 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3504 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3505 of additional information is limited.
3506
3507 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3508 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3509
3510 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3511
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003512
3513option log-separate-errors
3514no option log-separate-errors
3515 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3517 yes | yes | yes | no
3518 Arguments : none
3519
3520 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3521 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3522 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3523 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3524 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3525 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3526 provides very important information.
3527
3528 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3529 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3530 error logs.
3531
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003532 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003533 logging.
3534
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003535
3536option logasap
3537no option logasap
3538 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3540 yes | yes | yes | no
3541 Arguments : none
3542
3543 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3544 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3545 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3546 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3547 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3548 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3549 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003550 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003551 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3552 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3553
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003554 Examples :
3555 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3556 mode http
3557 option httplog
3558 option logasap
3559 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3560
3561 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3562 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3563 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3564 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003566 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003567 logging.
3568
3569
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003570option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3571 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3573 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003574 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003575 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3576 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003577
3578 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3579 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3580 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3581 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3582 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3583 in the MySQL table, like this :
3584
3585 USE mysql;
3586 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3587 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3588
3589 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3590 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3591 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3592 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3593 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3594 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3595 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3596 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3597 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3598
3599 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3600 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003601
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003602 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003603
3604 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3605 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3606 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3607 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3608 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3609 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3610
3611 See also: "option httpchk"
3612
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003613option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3614 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3616 yes | no | yes | yes
3617 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003618 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3619 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003620
3621 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3622 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3623 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3624 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3625
3626 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003627
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003628option nolinger
3629no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003630 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003631 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3632 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003633 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003634
3635 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3636 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3637 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3638 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3639 connections.
3640
3641 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3642 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3643 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3644 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3645 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3646 this too.
3647
3648 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3649 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3650 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3651
3652 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3653 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3654 for servers.
3655
3656 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3657 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3658
3659
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003660option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3661 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3663 yes | yes | yes | yes
3664 Arguments :
3665 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3666 matching <network>
3667 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3668 header name.
3669
3670 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3671 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3672 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3673 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3674 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3675 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3676 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3677 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3678 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3679 possible that the client has already brought one.
3680
3681 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3682 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3683 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3684 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3685 header and requires different one.
3686
3687 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3688 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3689 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3690 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3691 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3692 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3693 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3694
3695 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3696 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3697 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3698 both are defined.
3699
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003700 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3701 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3702 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3703 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3704 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003705
3706 Examples :
3707 # Original Destination address
3708 frontend www
3709 mode http
3710 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3711
3712 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3713 backend www
3714 mode http
3715 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3716
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003717 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3718 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003719
3720
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003721option persist
3722no option persist
3723 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3724 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3725 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003726 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003727
3728 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3729 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3730 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3731 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3732 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3733 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3734 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3735 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3736 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3737 redirected to another valid server.
3738
3739 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3740 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3741
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003742 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003743
3744
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003745option redispatch
3746no option redispatch
3747 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3748 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3749 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003750 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003751
3752 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3753 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3754 be able to access the service anymore.
3755
3756 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3757 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3758
3759 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3760 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3761 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003762
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003763 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3764 "redisp" keywords.
3765
3766 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3767 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3768
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003769 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003770
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003771
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003772option redis-check
3773 Use redis health checks for server testing
3774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3775 yes | no | yes | yes
3776 Arguments : none
3777
3778 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3779 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3780 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3781 find the "+PONG" response message.
3782
3783 Example :
3784 option redis-check
3785
3786 See also : "option httpchk"
3787
3788
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003789option smtpchk
3790option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3791 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3793 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003794 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003795 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3796 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3797 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3798
3799 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3800 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3801 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3802
3803 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3804 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3805 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3806 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3807 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3808 dead server.
3809
3810 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3811 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3812 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3813 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3814
3815 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3816 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3817 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3818 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3819 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3820
3821 Example :
3822 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3823
3824 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3825
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003827option socket-stats
3828no option socket-stats
3829
3830 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3832 yes | yes | yes | no
3833
3834 Arguments : none
3835
3836
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003837option splice-auto
3838no option splice-auto
3839 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3841 yes | yes | yes | yes
3842 Arguments : none
3843
3844 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3845 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3846 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3847 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003848 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003849 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3850 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3851 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3852 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3853
3854 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3855 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3856 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3857 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3858 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3859 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3860 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3861 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3862 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3863 keyword.
3864
3865 Example :
3866 option splice-auto
3867
3868 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3869 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3870
3871 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3872 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3873
3874
3875option splice-request
3876no option splice-request
3877 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3879 yes | yes | yes | yes
3880 Arguments : none
3881
3882 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003883 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003884 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3885 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3886 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3887 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3888
3889 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3890
3891 Example :
3892 option splice-request
3893
3894 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3895 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3896
3897 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3898 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3899
3900
3901option splice-response
3902no option splice-response
3903 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3905 yes | yes | yes | yes
3906 Arguments : none
3907
3908 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003909 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003910 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3911 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3912 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3913 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3914
3915 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3916
3917 Example :
3918 option splice-response
3919
3920 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3921 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3922
3923 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3924 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3925
3926
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003927option srvtcpka
3928no option srvtcpka
3929 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3931 yes | no | yes | yes
3932 Arguments : none
3933
3934 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3935 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3936 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3937 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3938
3939 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3940 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3941 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3942 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3943
3944 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3945 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3946 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3947 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3948 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3949
3950 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3951
3952 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3953 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3954 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3955
3956 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3957 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3958
3959 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3960
3961
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003962option ssl-hello-chk
3963 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3965 yes | no | yes | yes
3966 Arguments : none
3967
3968 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3969 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3970 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3971 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3972 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3973 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3974 hello message.
3975
3976 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3977 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3978 messages, which is appreciable.
3979
3980 See also: "option httpchk"
3981
3982
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003983option tcp-smart-accept
3984no option tcp-smart-accept
3985 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3987 yes | yes | yes | no
3988 Arguments : none
3989
3990 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3991 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3992 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3993 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3994 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3995 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3996
3997 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3998 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3999 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4000 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4001
4002 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4003 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4004 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4005 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4006
4007 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4008 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4009 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4010
4011 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4012 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4013 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4014
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004015 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4016
4017
4018option tcp-smart-connect
4019no option tcp-smart-connect
4020 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4022 yes | no | yes | yes
4023 Arguments : none
4024
4025 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4026 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4027 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4028 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4029 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4030
4031 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4032 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4033 complex.
4034
4035 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4036 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4037 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4038
4039 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4040 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4041
4042 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4043
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004044
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004045option tcpka
4046 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4048 yes | yes | yes | yes
4049 Arguments : none
4050
4051 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4052 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4053 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4054 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4055
4056 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4057 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4058 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4059 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4060
4061 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4062 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4063 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4064 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4065 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4066
4067 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4068
4069 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4070 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4071 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4072 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4073 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4074 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4075 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4076 backends.
4077
4078 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4079
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004080
4081option tcplog
4082 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4084 yes | yes | yes | yes
4085 Arguments : none
4086
4087 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4088 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4089 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4090 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4091 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4092 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4093 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4094 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4095
4096 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4097
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004098 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004099
4100
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004101option transparent
4102no option transparent
4103 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004105 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004106 Arguments : none
4107
4108 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4109 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4110 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4111 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4112 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4113 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4114 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4115 appropriate server.
4116
4117 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4118 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4119
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004120 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004121 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004122
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004123
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004124persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004125persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004126 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4128 yes | no | yes | yes
4129 Arguments :
4130 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004131 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4132 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004133
4134 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4135 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4136 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4137 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4138 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4139 forwarded to this server.
4140
4141 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4142 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4143 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004144 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004145 a single "listen" section.
4146
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004147 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4148 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4149 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4150
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004151 Example :
4152 listen tse-farm
4153 bind :3389
4154 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4155 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4156 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4157 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4158 persist rdp-cookie
4159 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004160 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004161 balance rdp-cookie
4162 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4163 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4164
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004165 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4166 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004167
4168
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004169rate-limit sessions <rate>
4170 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4172 yes | yes | yes | no
4173 Arguments :
4174 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4175 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4176
4177 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4178 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4179 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4180 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4181 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4182 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4183
4184 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4185 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4186 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4187 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4188
4189 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4190 listen smtp
4191 mode tcp
4192 bind :25
4193 rate-limit sessions 10
4194 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4195
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004196 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4197 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4198 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004199
4200 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4201
4202
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004203redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4204redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4205redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004206 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4208 no | yes | yes | yes
4209
4210 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004211 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004212
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004213 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004214 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4215 the HTTP "Location" header.
4216
4217 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4218 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4219 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4220 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4221 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4222 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4223
4224 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4225 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4226 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4227 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4228 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4229 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4230 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4231 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4232 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004233
4234 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4235 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4236 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4237 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4238 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4239 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4240 location with a GET method.
4241
4242 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4243 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4244
4245 - "drop-query"
4246 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4247 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4248 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4249 with a location-type redirect.
4250
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004251 - "append-slash"
4252 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4253 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4254 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4255 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4256
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004257 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4258 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4259 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4260 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4261 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4262 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4263 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4264
4265 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4266 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4267 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4268 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4269 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4270 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4271 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004272
4273 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4274 acl clear dst_port 80
4275 acl secure dst_port 8080
4276 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004277 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004278 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004279 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4280
4281 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004282 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4283 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4284 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004285 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004286
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004287 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4288 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4289 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4290
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004291 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
4292 redirect scheme https if !{ is_ssl }
4293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004294 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004295
4296
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004297redisp (deprecated)
4298redispatch (deprecated)
4299 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4300 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4301 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004302 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004303
4304 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4305 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4306 be able to access the service anymore.
4307
4308 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4309 redistribute them to a working server.
4310
4311 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4312 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4313 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004314
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004315 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4316 "option redispatch" instead.
4317
4318 See also : "option redispatch"
4319
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004320
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004321reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004322 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4324 no | yes | yes | yes
4325 Arguments :
4326 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4327 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004328 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004329
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004330 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4331 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4332
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004333 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4334 the last header of an HTTP request.
4335
4336 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4337 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4338 responses.
4339
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004340 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4341 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4342 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4343
4344 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4345 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004346
4347
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004348reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4349reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004350 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4352 no | yes | yes | yes
4353 Arguments :
4354 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4355 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4356 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4357 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4358 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4359 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4360 ignores case.
4361
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004362 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4363 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4364
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004365 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4366 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4367 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4368 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004369 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004370
4371 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4372 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4373
4374 Example :
4375 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4376 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4377 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4378
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004379 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4380 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004381
4382
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004383reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4384reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004385 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4387 no | yes | yes | yes
4388 Arguments :
4389 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4390 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4391 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4392 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4393 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4394 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4395
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004396 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4397 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4398
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004399 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4400 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4401 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4402 next servers.
4403
4404 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4405 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4406 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4407
4408 Example :
4409 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4410 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4411 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4412
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004413 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4414 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004415
4416
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004417reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4418reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004419 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4421 no | yes | yes | yes
4422 Arguments :
4423 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4424 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4425 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4426 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4427 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4428 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4429 case.
4430
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004431 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4432 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4433
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004434 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4435 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4436 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4437 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004438 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004439
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004440 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004441 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004442 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004443
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004444 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4445 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4446
4447 Example :
4448 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4449 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4450 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4451
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004452 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4453 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004454
4455
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004456reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4457reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004458 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4460 no | yes | yes | yes
4461 Arguments :
4462 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4463 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4464 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4465 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4466 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4467 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4468 case.
4469
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004470 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4471 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4472
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004473 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4474 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4475 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4476 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4477
4478 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4479 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4480
4481 Example :
4482 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4483 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4484 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4485 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4486
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004487 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4488 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004489
4490
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004491reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4492reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004493 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4495 no | yes | yes | yes
4496 Arguments :
4497 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4498 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4499 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4500 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4501 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4502 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4503
4504 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4505 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4506 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4507 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004508 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004509
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004510 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4511 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4512
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004513 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4514 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4515 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4516
4517 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4518 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4519 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4520 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4521 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4522
4523 Example :
4524 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004525 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004526 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4527 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4528
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004529 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4530 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004531
4532
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004533reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4534reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004535 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4537 no | yes | yes | yes
4538 Arguments :
4539 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4540 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4541 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4542 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4543 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4544 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4545 ignores case.
4546
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004547 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4548 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4549
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004550 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4551 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004552 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4553 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4554 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004555 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4556 not set.
4557
4558 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4559 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4560 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4561 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4562 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4563
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004564 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004565 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4566 # block all others.
4567 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4568 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4569
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004570 # block bad guys
4571 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4572 reqitarpit . if badguys
4573
4574 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4575 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004576
4577
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004578retries <value>
4579 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4580 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4581 yes | no | yes | yes
4582 Arguments :
4583 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4584 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4585 default value is 3.
4586
4587 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4588 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4589 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4590
4591 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4592 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4593
4594 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4595 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4596
4597 See also : "option redispatch"
4598
4599
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004600rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004601 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4603 no | yes | yes | yes
4604 Arguments :
4605 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4606 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004607 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004608
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004609 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4610 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4611
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004612 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4613 the last header of an HTTP response.
4614
4615 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4616 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4617 responses.
4618
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004619 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4620 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004621
4622
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004623rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4624rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004625 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4627 no | yes | yes | yes
4628 Arguments :
4629 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4630 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4631 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4632 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4633 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4634 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4635 ignores case.
4636
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004637 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4638 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4639
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004640 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4641 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004642 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004643 client.
4644
4645 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4646 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4647 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4648
4649 Example :
4650 # remove the Server header from responses
4651 reqidel ^Server:.*
4652
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004653 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4654 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004655
4656
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004657rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4658rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004659 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4661 no | yes | yes | yes
4662 Arguments :
4663 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4664 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4665 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4666 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4667 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4668 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4669 ignores case.
4670
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004671 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4672 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4673
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004674 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4675 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4676 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4677 case-sensitive.
4678
4679 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004680 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4681 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4682 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004683
4684 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4685 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4686
4687 Example :
4688 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4689 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4690
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004691 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4692 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004693
4694
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004695rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4696rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004697 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4699 no | yes | yes | yes
4700 Arguments :
4701 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4702 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4703 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4704 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4705 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4706 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4707 ignores case.
4708
4709 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4710 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4711 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4712 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004713 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004714
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004715 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4716 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4717
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004718 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4719 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4720 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4721
4722 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4723 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4724 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4725 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4726 are not case-sensitive.
4727
4728 Example :
4729 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4730 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4731
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004732 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4733 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004734
4735
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004736server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004737 Declare a server in a backend
4738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4739 no | no | yes | yes
4740 Arguments :
4741 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004742 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4743 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004744
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004745 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4746 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4747 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4748 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004749 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4750 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4751 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4752 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4753 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4754 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004755
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004756 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004757 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4758 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4759 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4760 adding this value to the client's port.
4761
4762 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4763 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004764 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004765
4766 Examples :
4767 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4768 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4769
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004770 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4771 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004772
4773
4774source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004775source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004776source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004777 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4779 yes | no | yes | yes
4780 Arguments :
4781 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4782 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4783 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4784 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4785
4786 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4787 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004788 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4789 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4790 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004791
4792 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4793 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4794 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4795 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4796 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4797 <addr>.
4798
4799 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4800 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4801 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4802 port.
4803
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004804 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4805 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4806 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4807 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4808 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4809 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4810 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4811 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4812 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4813 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4814 HTTP header.
4815
4816 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4817 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004818 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004819 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4820 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4821 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4822 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4823 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4824 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4825 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4826
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004827 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4828 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4829 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4830 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4831 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4832 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4833
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004834 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4835 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4836 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4837 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4838
4839 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4840 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4841 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4842 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4843 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4844 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4845
4846 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4847 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4848 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4849 there are two methods :
4850
4851 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4852 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4853 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4854 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4855 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4856 of the client ranges may be used.
4857
4858 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4859 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4860 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4861 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4862 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4863 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4864 same session.
4865
4866 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4867 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4868 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4869 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4870 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4871 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4872
4873 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4874 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4875 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004876 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004877
4878 Examples :
4879 backend private
4880 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4881 source 192.168.1.200
4882
4883 backend transparent_ssl1
4884 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4885 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4886
4887 backend transparent_ssl2
4888 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4889 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4890 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4891
4892 backend transparent_ssl3
4893 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4894 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4895 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4896
4897 backend transparent_smtp
4898 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4899 # with Tproxy version 4.
4900 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4901
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004902 backend transparent_http
4903 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4904 # proxy.
4905 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004907 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004908 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4909
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004910
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004911srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4912 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4914 yes | no | yes | yes
4915 Arguments :
4916 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4917 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4918 as explained at the top of this document.
4919
4920 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4921 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4922 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4923 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4924 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4925 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4926 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4927
4928 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4929 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4930 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4931 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4932 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004933 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004934 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004935 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004936
4937 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4938 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4939 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4940 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4941 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4942 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4943
4944 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4945 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4946
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004947 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
4948 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004949
4950
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004951stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4952 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4954 no | no | yes | yes
4955
4956 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4957 matched.
4958
4959 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4960 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4961
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004962 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
4963 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
4964 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
4965
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01004966 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
4967 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
4968 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
4969 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004970
4971 Example :
4972 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4973 backend stats_localhost
4974 stats enable
4975 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4976
4977 Example :
4978 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4979 backend stats_auth
4980 stats enable
4981 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4982 stats admin if TRUE
4983
4984 Example :
4985 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4986 userlist stats-auth
4987 group admin users admin
4988 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4989 group readonly users haproxy
4990 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4991
4992 backend stats_auth
4993 stats enable
4994 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
4995 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
4996 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
4997 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
4998
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004999 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5000 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5001 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005002
5003
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005004stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5005 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5007 yes | no | yes | yes
5008 Arguments :
5009 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5010
5011 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5012
5013 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5014 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5015 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5016 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5017 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5018 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5019
5020 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5021 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5022 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005023 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005024
5025 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5026 report using "stats scope".
5027
5028 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5029 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5030 unobvious parameters.
5031
5032 Example :
5033 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5034 backend public_www
5035 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5036 stats enable
5037 stats hide-version
5038 stats scope .
5039 stats uri /admin?stats
5040 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5041 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5042 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5043
5044 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5045 backend private_monitoring
5046 stats enable
5047 stats uri /admin?stats
5048 stats refresh 5s
5049
5050 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5051
5052
5053stats enable
5054 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5056 yes | no | yes | yes
5057 Arguments : none
5058
5059 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5060 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5061 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5062 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5063 - stats auth : no authentication
5064 - stats scope : no restriction
5065
5066 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5067 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5068 unobvious parameters.
5069
5070 Example :
5071 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5072 backend public_www
5073 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5074 stats enable
5075 stats hide-version
5076 stats scope .
5077 stats uri /admin?stats
5078 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5079 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5080 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5081
5082 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5083 backend private_monitoring
5084 stats enable
5085 stats uri /admin?stats
5086 stats refresh 5s
5087
5088 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5089
5090
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005091stats hide-version
5092 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5094 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005095 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005096
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005097 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5098 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5099 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5100 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5101 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5102 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005103
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005104 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5105 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5106 unobvious parameters.
5107
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005108 Example :
5109 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5110 backend public_www
5111 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005112 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005113 stats hide-version
5114 stats scope .
5115 stats uri /admin?stats
5116 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5117 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5118 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005119
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005120 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5121 backend private_monitoring
5122 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005123 stats uri /admin?stats
5124 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005125
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005126 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005127
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005128
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005129stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5130 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5131 Access control for statistics
5132
5133 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5134 no | no | yes | yes
5135
5136 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5137 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5138 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5139 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5140 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5141 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5142
5143 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5144 instance.
5145
5146 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5147 about ACL usage.
5148
5149
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005150stats realm <realm>
5151 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5153 yes | no | yes | yes
5154 Arguments :
5155 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5156 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5157 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5158
5159 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5160 using a backslash ('\').
5161
5162 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5163 only related to authentication.
5164
5165 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5166 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5167 unobvious parameters.
5168
5169 Example :
5170 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5171 backend public_www
5172 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5173 stats enable
5174 stats hide-version
5175 stats scope .
5176 stats uri /admin?stats
5177 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5178 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5179 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5180
5181 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5182 backend private_monitoring
5183 stats enable
5184 stats uri /admin?stats
5185 stats refresh 5s
5186
5187 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5188
5189
5190stats refresh <delay>
5191 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5193 yes | no | yes | yes
5194 Arguments :
5195 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5196 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5197 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5198 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5199 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5200 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5201
5202 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5203 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5204 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5205 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5206
5207 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5208 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5209 unobvious parameters.
5210
5211 Example :
5212 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5213 backend public_www
5214 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5215 stats enable
5216 stats hide-version
5217 stats scope .
5218 stats uri /admin?stats
5219 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5220 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5221 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5222
5223 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5224 backend private_monitoring
5225 stats enable
5226 stats uri /admin?stats
5227 stats refresh 5s
5228
5229 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5230
5231
5232stats scope { <name> | "." }
5233 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5235 yes | no | yes | yes
5236 Arguments :
5237 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5238 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5239 section in which the statement appears.
5240
5241 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5242 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5243 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5244 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5245 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5246 exists.
5247
5248 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5249 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5250 unobvious parameters.
5251
5252 Example :
5253 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5254 backend public_www
5255 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5256 stats enable
5257 stats hide-version
5258 stats scope .
5259 stats uri /admin?stats
5260 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5261 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5262 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5263
5264 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5265 backend private_monitoring
5266 stats enable
5267 stats uri /admin?stats
5268 stats refresh 5s
5269
5270 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5271
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005272
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005273stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005274 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5276 yes | no | yes | yes
5277
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005278 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005279 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5280
5281 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5282 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5283
5284 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5285 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005286 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005287
5288 Example :
5289 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5290 backend private_monitoring
5291 stats enable
5292 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5293 stats uri /admin?stats
5294 stats refresh 5s
5295
5296 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5297 global section.
5298
5299
5300stats show-legends
5301 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5302 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5303 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5304 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5305 - IP (socket, server)
5306 - cookie (backend, server)
5307
5308 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5309 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005310 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005311
5312 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5313
5314
5315stats show-node [ <name> ]
5316 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5318 yes | no | yes | yes
5319 Arguments:
5320 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5321 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5322
5323 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5324 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005325 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005326
5327 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5328 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5329 unobvious parameters.
5330
5331 Example:
5332 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5333 backend private_monitoring
5334 stats enable
5335 stats show-node Europe-1
5336 stats uri /admin?stats
5337 stats refresh 5s
5338
5339 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5340 section.
5341
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005342
5343stats uri <prefix>
5344 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5346 yes | no | yes | yes
5347 Arguments :
5348 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5349 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5350 query string.
5351
5352 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5353 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5354 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5355 possible to reach it in the application.
5356
5357 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005358 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005359 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5360 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5361 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5362 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5363
5364 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5365 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5366 an address or a port to statistics only.
5367
5368 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5369 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5370 unobvious parameters.
5371
5372 Example :
5373 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5374 backend public_www
5375 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5376 stats enable
5377 stats hide-version
5378 stats scope .
5379 stats uri /admin?stats
5380 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5381 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5382 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5383
5384 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5385 backend private_monitoring
5386 stats enable
5387 stats uri /admin?stats
5388 stats refresh 5s
5389
5390 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5391
5392
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005393stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5394 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005396 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005397
5398 Arguments :
5399 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5400 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5401 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5402 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5403
5404 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5405 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5406 the "stick-table" statement.
5407
5408 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5409 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5410 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5411 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5412 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5413
5414 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5415 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5416 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5417 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5418 transformation rules.
5419
5420 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5421 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5422 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5423 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5424 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5425 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5426 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5427
5428 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5429 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5430 ACL based conditions.
5431
5432 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5433 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5434 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5435 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5436
5437 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5438 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5439 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5440 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5441
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005442 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5443 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5444 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5445
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005446 Example :
5447 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5448 # last 30 minutes
5449 backend pop
5450 mode tcp
5451 balance roundrobin
5452 stick store-request src
5453 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5454 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5455 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5456
5457 backend smtp
5458 mode tcp
5459 balance roundrobin
5460 stick match src table pop
5461 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5462 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5463
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005464 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5465 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005466
5467
5468stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5469 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5471 no | no | yes | yes
5472
5473 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5474 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5475 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5476 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5477
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005478 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5479 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5480 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5481
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005482 Examples :
5483 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005484 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005485
5486 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5487 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5488 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5489
5490
5491 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5492 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5493 backend http
5494 mode http
5495 balance roundrobin
5496 stick on src table https
5497 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5498 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5499 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5500
5501 backend https
5502 mode tcp
5503 balance roundrobin
5504 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5505 stick on src
5506 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5507 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5508
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005509 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005510
5511
5512stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5513 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5515 no | no | yes | yes
5516
5517 Arguments :
5518 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5519 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5520 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5521 server is selected.
5522
5523 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5524 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5525 the "stick-table" statement.
5526
5527 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5528 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5529 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5530 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5531 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5532 address.
5533
5534 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5535 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5536 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5537 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5538 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5539 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5540 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5541 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5542 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5543 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5544
5545 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5546 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5547 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5548 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5549 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5550 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5551 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5552
5553 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5554 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5555 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5556 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5557
5558 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5559 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5560 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5561 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5562 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5563 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5564 another protocol or access method.
5565
5566 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5567 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5568 the request.
5569
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005570 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5571 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5572 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5573
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005574 Example :
5575 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5576 # last 30 minutes
5577 backend pop
5578 mode tcp
5579 balance roundrobin
5580 stick store-request src
5581 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5582 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5583 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5584
5585 backend smtp
5586 mode tcp
5587 balance roundrobin
5588 stick match src table pop
5589 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5590 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5591
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005592 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5593 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005594
5595
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005596stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005597 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5598 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005599 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005601 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005602
5603 Arguments :
5604 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5605 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5606 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5607 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5608
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005609 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5610 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5611 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5612 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5613
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005614 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5615 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5616 instance.
5617
5618 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5619 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5620 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5621 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5622 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5623 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005624 to 32 characters.
5625
5626 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5627 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5628 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5629 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5630 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5631 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005632
5633 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005634 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5635 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005636 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5637 increase.
5638
5639 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005640 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5641 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5642 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005643
5644 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5645 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5646 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5647 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5648 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5649 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5650 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5651 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5652 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5653 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5654 parameter (see below).
5655
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005656 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5657 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5658 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5659 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5660 soft restart.
5661
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005662 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5663
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005664 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5665 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5666 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5667 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5668 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005669 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005670 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5671 if not expiration delay is specified.
5672
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005673 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5674 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5675 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5676 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005677 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5678 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5679 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5680 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5681 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5682 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5683 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5684 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5685 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5686 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5687 types and their arguments.
5688
5689 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5690 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5691 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5692 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5693
5694 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5695 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5696 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5697 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5698
5699 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5700 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5701 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5702 they were received.
5703
5704 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5705 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5706 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5707 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5708 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5709
5710 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5711 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5712 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5713 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5714 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5715
5716 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5717 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5718 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5719
5720 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5721 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5722 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5723 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5724 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5725
5726 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5727 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5728 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5729 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5730 the client side.
5731
5732 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5733 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5734 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5735 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5736 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5737 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5738 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5739
5740 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5741 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5742 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5743 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5744 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5745 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5746 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5747
5748 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5749 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5750 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5751 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5752 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5753 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5754
5755 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5756 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5757 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5758 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5759
5760 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5761 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5762 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5763 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5764 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5765 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5766 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5767 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5768 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5769 recommended for better fairness.
5770
5771 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5772 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5773 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5774 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5775
5776 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5777 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5778 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5779 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5780 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5781 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5782 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5783 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5784 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5785 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005786
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005787 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5788 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005789 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5790 reference it.
5791
5792 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5793 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5794 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5795 as an exclusive stickiness.
5796
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005797 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5798 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5799 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5800 something that can be ignored.
5801
5802 Example:
5803 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5804 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5805 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5806 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5807
5808 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005809 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005810
5811
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005812stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5813 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5815 no | no | yes | yes
5816
5817 Arguments :
5818 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5819 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5820 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5821 server is selected.
5822
5823 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5824 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5825 the "stick-table" statement.
5826
5827 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5828 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5829 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5830 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5831
5832 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5833 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5834 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5835 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5836 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5837 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005838 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005839 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5840 rules.
5841
5842 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5843 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5844 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5845 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5846 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5847 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5848 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5849
5850 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5851 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5852 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5853 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5854
5855 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5856 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5857 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5858 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5859 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5860 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5861 another protocol or access method.
5862
5863 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5864
5865 Example :
5866 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5867 backend https
5868 mode tcp
5869 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005870 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005871 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005872
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005873 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5874 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5875
5876 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5877 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5878 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5879
5880 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5881 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005882
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005883 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5884 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5885 # at offset 44.
5886
5887 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5888 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5889
5890 # Learn on response if server hello.
5891 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005892
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005893 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5894 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5895
5896 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5897 extraction.
5898
5899
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005900tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5901 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5903 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005904 Arguments :
5905 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5906 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5907 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005908
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005909 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005910
5911 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5912 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005913 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5914 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5915 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5916 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5917 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5918 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005919
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005920 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5921 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5922 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5923 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005924
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005925 Three types of actions are supported :
5926 - accept :
5927 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5928 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5929 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005930
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005931 - reject :
5932 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5933 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5934 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5935 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5936 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5937 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5938 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5939 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5940 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5941 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5942 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5943 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005944
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005945 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5946 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5947 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5948 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5949 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5950 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5951 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5952 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5953 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005954
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005955 These actions take one or two arguments :
5956 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5957 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5958 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005960 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5961 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5962 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5963 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005964
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005965 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5966 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5967 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5968 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5969 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5970 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5971 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5972 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5973 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5974 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005975
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005976 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5977 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5978 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005979
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005980 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5981 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5982 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005983
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005984 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005985 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005986 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005987
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005988 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5989 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5990 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005991
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005992 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5993 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5994 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005995
5996 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5997
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005998 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005999
6000
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006001tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6002 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006004 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006005 Arguments :
6006 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6007 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6008 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006009
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006010 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006011
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006012 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6013 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6014 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6015 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6016 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006018 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6019 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6020 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6021 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6022 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6023 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6024 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6025 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6026 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006028 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6029 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6030 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6031 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006032
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006033 Three types of actions are supported :
6034 - accept :
6035 - reject :
6036 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006037
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006038 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6039 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006040
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006041 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6042 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6043 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6044 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6045 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6046 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006047
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006048 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006049 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6050 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006051
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006052 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006053 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6054 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6055 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6056 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6057 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006058
6059 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006060 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6061 # and reject everything else.
6062 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6063 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006064 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006065 tcp-request content reject
6066
6067 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006068 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6069 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6070 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006071 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006072
6073 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6074 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6075 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006076 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006077 tcp-request content reject
6078
6079 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6080 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6081
6082 frontend http
6083 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6084 # protecting all our sites
6085 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6086 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6087 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6088 ...
6089 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6090
6091 backend http_dynamic
6092 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6093 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6094 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6095 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6096 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6097 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6098 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006100 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006101
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006102 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006103
6104
6105tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6106 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006108 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006109 Arguments :
6110 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6111 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6112 as explained at the top of this document.
6113
6114 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6115 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6116 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6117 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6118 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6119
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006120 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6121 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6122 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6123 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6124
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006125 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6126 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006127 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006128 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006129 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6130 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6131 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6132 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006133
6134 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6135 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6136 it pass through unaffected.
6137
6138 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6139 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6140 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006141 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006142 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6143 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006144 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6145 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6146 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006147
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006148 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006149 "timeout client".
6150
6151
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006152tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6153 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6155 no | no | yes | yes
6156 Arguments :
6157 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6158 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6159 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6160
6161 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6162
6163 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6164 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6165 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6166 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006167 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006168
6169 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6170
6171 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6172 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6173 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6174 inserted.
6175
6176 Two types of actions are supported :
6177 - accept :
6178 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6179 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6180 the rules evaluation.
6181
6182 - reject :
6183 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6184 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006185 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006186
6187 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6188 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6189 for changing the default action to a reject.
6190
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006191 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6192 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6193 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6194 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006195 period.
6196
6197 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6198
6199 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6200
6201
6202tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6203 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6205 no | no | yes | yes
6206 Arguments :
6207 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6208 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6209 as explained at the top of this document.
6210
6211 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6212
6213
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006214timeout check <timeout>
6215 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6216 established.
6217
6218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6219 yes | no | yes | yes
6220 Arguments:
6221 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6222 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6223 as explained at the top of this document.
6224
6225 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6226 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6227 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6228 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006229 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6230 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6231 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006232
6233 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6234 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6235
6236 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6237 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006238 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006239
6240 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6241 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6242 forget about it.
6243
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006244 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6245 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006246
6247
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006248timeout client <timeout>
6249timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6250 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6252 yes | yes | yes | no
6253 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006254 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006255 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6256 as explained at the top of this document.
6257
6258 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6259 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6260 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6261 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6262 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6263 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6264 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6265 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006266 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006267 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006268 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6269 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6270 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006271
6272 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6273 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6274 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6275 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6276 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6277 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6278
6279 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6280 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6281 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6282
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006283 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006284
6285
6286timeout connect <timeout>
6287timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6288 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6290 yes | no | yes | yes
6291 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006292 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006293 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6294 as explained at the top of this document.
6295
6296 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006297 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006298 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006299 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006300 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6301 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006302
6303 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6304 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6305 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6306 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6307 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6308 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6309
6310 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6311 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6312 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6313
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006314 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6315 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006316
6317
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006318timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6319 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6321 yes | yes | yes | yes
6322 Arguments :
6323 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6324 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6325 as explained at the top of this document.
6326
6327 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6328 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6329 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6330 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6331 once the request has started to present itself.
6332
6333 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6334 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6335 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6336 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6337 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6338
6339 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6340 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6341 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6342 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6343
6344 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6345 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6346 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6347 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6348 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006349 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006350
6351 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6352 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6353 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6354 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6355
6356 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6357
6358
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006359timeout http-request <timeout>
6360 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006362 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006363 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006364 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006365 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6366 as explained at the top of this document.
6367
6368 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6369 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6370 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6371 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6372 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6373 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6374 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6375 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6376
6377 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6378 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006379 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6380 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006381
6382 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6383 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6384 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6385 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6386 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6387
6388 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006389 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6390 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6391 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006392
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006393 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006394
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006395
6396timeout queue <timeout>
6397 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6399 yes | no | yes | yes
6400 Arguments :
6401 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6402 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6403 as explained at the top of this document.
6404
6405 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6406 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6407 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6408 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6409 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6410
6411 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6412 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6413 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6414 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6415
6416 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6417
6418
6419timeout server <timeout>
6420timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6421 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6423 yes | no | yes | yes
6424 Arguments :
6425 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6426 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6427 as explained at the top of this document.
6428
6429 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6430 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6431 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6432 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6433 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6434 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6435 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6436
6437 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6438 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6439 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6440 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6441 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006442 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006443 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006444 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6445 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6446 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6447 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006448
6449 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6450 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6451 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6452 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6453 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6454 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6455
6456 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6457 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6458 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6459
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006460 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006461
6462
6463timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006464 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6466 yes | yes | yes | yes
6467 Arguments :
6468 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6469 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6470 as explained at the top of this document.
6471
6472 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6473 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6474 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6475
6476 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6477 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6478 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6479 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006480 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006481
6482 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6483
6484
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006485timeout tunnel <timeout>
6486 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6488 yes | no | yes | yes
6489 Arguments :
6490 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6491 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6492 as explained at the top of this document.
6493
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006494 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006495 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6496 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6497 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6498 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6499 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6500 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6501 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6502 specified.
6503
6504 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6505 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6506 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6507 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6508 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6509
6510 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6511 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6512 forget about it.
6513
6514 Example :
6515 defaults http
6516 option http-server-close
6517 timeout connect 5s
6518 timeout client 30s
6519 timeout client 30s
6520 timeout server 30s
6521 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6522
6523 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6524
6525
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006526transparent (deprecated)
6527 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006529 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006530 Arguments : none
6531
6532 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6533 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6534 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6535 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6536 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6537 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6538 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6539 appropriate server.
6540
6541 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6542
6543 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6544 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6545
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006546 See also: "option transparent"
6547
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006548unique-id-format <string>
6549 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6551 yes | yes | yes | no
6552 Arguments :
6553 <string> is a log-format string.
6554
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006555 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6556 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6557 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6558 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006559
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006560 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6561 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6562 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6563 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6564 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6565 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6566 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6567 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006568
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006569 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6570 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006571
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006572 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006573
6574 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6575
6576 will generate:
6577
6578 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6579
6580 See also: "unique-id-header"
6581
6582unique-id-header <name>
6583 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6585 yes | yes | yes | no
6586 Arguments :
6587 <name> is the name of the header.
6588
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006589 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6590 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006591
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006592 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006593
6594 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6595 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6596
6597 will generate:
6598
6599 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6600
6601 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006602
6603use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6604use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006605 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6607 no | yes | yes | no
6608 Arguments :
6609 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006611 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006612
6613 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6614 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6615 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006616 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6617 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6618 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6619 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006620
6621 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6622 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6623 assign the backend.
6624
6625 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6626 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6627 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6628 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6629 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6630 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6631
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006632 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006633 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006634 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6635 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6636 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6637
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006638 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006639
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006640
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006641use-server <server> if <condition>
6642use-server <server> unless <condition>
6643 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6645 no | no | yes | yes
6646 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006647 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006648
6649 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6650
6651 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6652 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6653 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6654
6655 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6656 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6657 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6658 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6659 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6660 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6661 matches will assign the server.
6662
6663 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6664 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6665 with the next rules until one matches.
6666
6667 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6668 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6669 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6670 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6671
6672 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6673 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6674 stripped.
6675
6676 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6677 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6678 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6679 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6680
6681 Example :
6682 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6683 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6684 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6685 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6686 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6687 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6688 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6689 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6690 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6691
6692 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6693
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006694
66955. Bind and Server options
6696--------------------------
6697
6698The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6699depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6700settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6701written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6702described in this section.
6703
6704
67055.1. Bind options
6706-----------------
6707
6708The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6709as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6710no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6711parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6712while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6713provided immediately after the setting name.
6714
6715The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6716
6717accept-proxy
6718 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6719 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6720 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6721 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6722 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6723 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6724 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6725 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6726 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6727 usable.
6728
6729backlog <backlog>
6730 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
6731 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
6732
6733ciphers <ciphers>
6734 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6735 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
6736 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
6737 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
6738 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
6739
6740crt <cert>
6741 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6742 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
6743 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
6744 files into one. If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all
6745 files found in that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified
6746 multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
6747 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
6748 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
6749 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
6750 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
6751 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
6752 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the
6753 client provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first
6754 loaded certificate will be presented. This means that when loading
6755 certificates from a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default
6756 one first as a file. Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times
6757 without side effects.
6758
6759defer-accept
6760 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6761 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
6762 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
6763 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
6764 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
6765 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
6766 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
6767 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
6768 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
6769 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
6770 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
6771
6772gid <gid>
6773 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
6774 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6775 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
6776 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
6777 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6778
6779group <group>
6780 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
6781 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
6782 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
6783 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
6784 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6785
6786id <id>
6787 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
6788 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
6789 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
6790 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
6791
6792interface <interface>
6793 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
6794 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
6795 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
6796 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
6797 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
6798 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
6799 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
6800 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
6801
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02006802level <level>
6803 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
6804 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
6805 sockets. <level> can be one of :
6806 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
6807 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
6808 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
6809 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
6810 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
6811 counters).
6812 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
6813 all counters).
6814
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006815maxconn <maxconn>
6816 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
6817 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
6818 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
6819 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
6820 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
6821 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
6822 eat all memory.
6823
6824mode <mode>
6825 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
6826 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
6827 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
6828 UNIX sockets.
6829
6830mss <maxseg>
6831 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
6832 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
6833 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
6834 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
6835 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
6836 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
6837 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
6838 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
6839 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
6840 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
6841 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
6842
6843name <name>
6844 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
6845 page.
6846
6847nice <nice>
6848 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
6849 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
6850 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
6851 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
6852 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
6853 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
6854 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
6855 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
6856 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
6857 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
6858 one for an RDP socket.
6859
6860nosslv3
6861 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6862 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
6863 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
6864 be enabled using any configuration option.
6865
6866notlsv1
6867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6868 disables support for TLSv1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
6869 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
6870 be enabled using any configuration option.
6871
6872prefer-server-ciphers
6873 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6874 tells the SSL/TLS layer that our set of cipher algorithms is preferred over
6875 the client's ones.
6876
6877ssl
6878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6879 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
6880 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
6881 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
6882 to deciphered contents.
6883
6884transparent
6885 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6886 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
6887 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
6888 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
6889 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
6890 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
6891 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
6892 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
6893 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
6894 so check for support with your vendor.
6895
6896uid <uid>
6897 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
6898 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6899 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
6900 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
6901 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6902
6903user <user>
6904 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
6905 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6906 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
6907 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
6908 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6909
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006910
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020069115.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006912------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006913
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006914The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6915which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6916arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6917settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6918after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6919Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6920address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006922 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006923 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006924
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006925The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006926
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02006927addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006928 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6929 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6930 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6931 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6932 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006933
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006934 Supported in default-server: No
6935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006936backup
6937 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6938 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6939 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6940 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6941 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6942 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006944 Supported in default-server: No
6945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006946check
6947 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01006948 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
6949 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
6950 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
6951 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
6952 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
6953 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
6954 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
6955 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
6956 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
6957 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006958
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006959 Supported in default-server: No
6960
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02006961ciphers <ciphers>
6962 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
6963 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
6964 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
6965 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
6966 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
6967 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
6968 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
6969 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
6970
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006971cookie <value>
6972 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6973 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6974 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6975 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6976 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6977 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6978 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006980 Supported in default-server: No
6981
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006982disabled
6983 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6984 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6985 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6986 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6987 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6988
6989 Supported in default-server: No
6990
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006991error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006992 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6993 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6994 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006995
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006996 Supported in default-server: Yes
6997
6998 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007000fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007001 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7002 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7003 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007005 Supported in default-server: Yes
7006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007007id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007008 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7009 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7010 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007011
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007012 Supported in default-server: No
7013
7014inter <delay>
7015fastinter <delay>
7016downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007017 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7018 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7019 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7020 between checks depending on the server state :
7021
7022 Server state | Interval used
7023 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7024 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7025 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7026 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7027 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7028 or yet unchecked. |
7029 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7030 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7031 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007033 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7034 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7035 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7036 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7037 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7038 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7039 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7040 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7041 servers.
7042
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007043 Supported in default-server: Yes
7044
7045maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007046 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7047 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7048 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7049 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7050 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7051 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7052 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7053 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007055 Supported in default-server: Yes
7056
7057maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007058 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7059 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7060 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7061 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7062 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7063 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7064 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7065
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007066 Supported in default-server: Yes
7067
7068minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007069 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7070 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7071 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7072 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7073 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7074 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007075 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007076 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007077
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007078 Supported in default-server: Yes
7079
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007080nosslv3
7081 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7082 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7083 using any configuration option.
7084
7085notlsv1
7086 This option disables support for TLSv1 when SSL is used to communicate with
7087 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7088 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
7089 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers.
7090
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007091non-stick
7092 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7093 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7094 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7095
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007096observe <mode>
7097 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7098 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7099 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7100 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7101 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7102 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007103 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007105 Supported in default-server: No
7106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007107 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7108
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007109on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007110 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7111 Currently, four modes are available:
7112 - fastinter: force fastinter
7113 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7114 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7115 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7116 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7117
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007118 Supported in default-server: Yes
7119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007120 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7121
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007122on-marked-down <action>
7123 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7124 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007125 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7126 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7127 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7128 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7129 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7130 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7131 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7132 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007133
7134 Actions are disabled by default
7135
7136 Supported in default-server: Yes
7137
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007138on-marked-up <action>
7139 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7140 Currently one action is available:
7141 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7142 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7143 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7144 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7145 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7146 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7147 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7148 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7149
7150 Actions are disabled by default
7151
7152 Supported in default-server: Yes
7153
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007154port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007155 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7156 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7157 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7158 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7159 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7160 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007162 Supported in default-server: Yes
7163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007164redir <prefix>
7165 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7166 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7167 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7168 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7169 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7170 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7171 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7172 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007173 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007174 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7175 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7176 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7177 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7178 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7179
7180 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7181
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007182 Supported in default-server: No
7183
7184rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007185 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7186 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7187 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7188
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007189 Supported in default-server: Yes
7190
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007191send-proxy
7192 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7193 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7194 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7195 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7196 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7197 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7198 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7199 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7200 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
7201 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
7202 option of the "bind" keyword.
7203
7204 Supported in default-server: No
7205
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007206slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007207 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7208 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7209 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7210 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7211 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7212 parameters :
7213
7214 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7215 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7216
7217 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7218 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7219 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7220 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7221
7222 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7223 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7224 seen as failed.
7225
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007226 Supported in default-server: Yes
7227
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007228source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007229source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007230source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007231 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7232 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7233 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7234 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7235
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007236 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7237 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7238 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7239 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7240 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7241 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7242 server.
7243
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007244 Supported in default-server: No
7245
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007246ssl
7247 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7248 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7249 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7250 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7251 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications.
7252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007253track [<proxy>/]<server>
7254 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7255 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7256 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7257 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7258 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7259
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007260 Supported in default-server: No
7261
7262weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007263 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7264 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7265 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007266 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7267 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7268 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7269 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7270 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7271 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007272
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007273 Supported in default-server: Yes
7274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007275
72766. HTTP header manipulation
7277---------------------------
7278
7279In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7280response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7281request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7282which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7283against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7284to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7285passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7286headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7287never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007289There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7290(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7291rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7292messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7293in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007294happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007295add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7296normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007298This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7299in section 4.2 :
7300
7301 - reqadd <string>
7302 - reqallow <search>
7303 - reqiallow <search>
7304 - reqdel <search>
7305 - reqidel <search>
7306 - reqdeny <search>
7307 - reqideny <search>
7308 - reqpass <search>
7309 - reqipass <search>
7310 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7311 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7312 - reqtarpit <search>
7313 - reqitarpit <search>
7314 - rspadd <string>
7315 - rspdel <search>
7316 - rspidel <search>
7317 - rspdeny <search>
7318 - rspideny <search>
7319 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7320 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7321
7322With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7323is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7324parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7325prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7326Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7327
7328 \t for a tab
7329 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7330 \n for a new line (LF)
7331 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7332 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7333 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7334 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7335 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7336
7337The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7338portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7339above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7340regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
73419 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7342is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7343
7344The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7345after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7346
7347Notes related to these keywords :
7348---------------------------------
7349 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7350 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7351 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7352
7353 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7354 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7355 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7356
7357 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7358 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7359 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7360 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7361 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7362
7363 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7364 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7365 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7366 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7367 useless headers before adding new ones.
7368
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007369 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007370 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7371
7372 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7373 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7374 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7375
7376 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7377 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007378 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007379
7380
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010073817. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7382------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007383
7384The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7385content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7386from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7387simple :
7388
7389 - define test criteria with sets of values
7390 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7391
7392The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7393
7394In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7395
7396 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7397
7398This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7399Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7400and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7401an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7402of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7403
7404ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7405'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7406which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7407
7408There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7409performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7410
7411The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7412
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007413 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7414 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007415 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7416
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007417The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7418specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7419possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007420multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7421be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7422needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7423space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7424match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7425lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7426duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007427to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007428instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007429
7430 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7431
7432In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7433the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7434case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7435too.
7436
7437Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7438a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7439ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7440
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007441Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007442
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007443 - integers or integer ranges
7444 - strings
7445 - regular expressions
7446 - IP addresses and networks
7447
7448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074497.1. Matching integers
7450----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007451
7452Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7453that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7454expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7455may be omitted.
7456
7457For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7458unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7459representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7460
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007461As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7462two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7463instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7464ranges and operators.
7465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007466For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007467operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7468Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7469of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007470
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007471Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007472
7473 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7474 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7475 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7476 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7477 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7478
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007479For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007480
7481 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7482
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007483This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7484
7485 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7486
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074887.2. Matching strings
7489---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007490
7491String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7492exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7493characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7494string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7495to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007496before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007497
7498
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074997.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7500-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007501
7502Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7503they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7504possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7505passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7506the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007507the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7508match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007509
7510
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020075117.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007512----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007513
7514IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7515netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7516within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007517host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007518difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7519at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7520does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7521parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007522
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007523IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7524Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7525trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7526IPv6 patterns.
7527
7528HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7529following situations :
7530 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7531 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7532 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7533 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7534 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7535 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7536 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7537 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7538 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7539 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075427.5. Available matching criteria
7543--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075457.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7546------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007547
7548A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7549analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007550addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007551
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007552always_false
7553 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7554 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7555
7556always_true
7557 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7558 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7559
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007560avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007561avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007562 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7563 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7564 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7565 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7566 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7567 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7568 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7569 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7570 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7571 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7572 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007573
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007574be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007575be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007576 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7577 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7578 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7579 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7580 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007581
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007582be_id <integer>
7583 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7584 backend it was called.
7585
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007586be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007587be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007588 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7589 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7590 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7591 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7592 sucking of an online dictionary).
7593
7594 Example :
7595 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7596 backend dynamic
7597 mode http
7598 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7599 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007600
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007601connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007602connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007603 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007604 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007605 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7606
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007607 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7608 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007609
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007610 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007611 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7612 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7613 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7614 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7615 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007616 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007617
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007618 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7619 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7620 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7621 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007622
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007623dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007624 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7625 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007626
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007627dst_conn <integer>
7628 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7629 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7630 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7631 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7632 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7633 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7634
7635dst_port <integer>
7636 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7637 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7638
7639fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007640fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007641 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7642 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7643 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7644 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7645 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7646 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7647 criteria.
7648
7649fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007650 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007651 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007652
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007653fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007654fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007655 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7656 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7657 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7658 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7659 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7660 the rate to go down below the limit.
7661
7662 Example :
7663 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7664 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7665 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7666 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7667 frontend mail
7668 bind :25
7669 mode tcp
7670 maxconn 100
7671 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7672 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7673 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7674 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007675
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007676nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007677nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007678 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7679 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7680 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7681 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7682 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007683
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007684queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007685queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007686 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7687 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7688 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7689 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7690 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7691 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7692 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7693
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007694sc1_bytes_in_rate
7695sc2_bytes_in_rate
7696 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7697 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7698 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7699
7700sc1_bytes_out_rate
7701sc2_bytes_out_rate
7702 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7703 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7704 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7705
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007706sc1_clr_gpc0
7707sc2_clr_gpc0
7708 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7709 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7710 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7711 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7712 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7713 was verified :
7714
7715 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7716 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7717 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7718 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7719 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7720 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7721 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7722
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007723sc1_conn_cnt
7724sc2_conn_cnt
7725 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7726 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7727
7728sc1_conn_cur
7729sc2_conn_cur
7730 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7731 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7732 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7733
7734sc1_conn_rate
7735sc2_conn_rate
7736 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7737 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7738 See also src_conn_rate.
7739
7740sc1_get_gpc0
7741sc2_get_gpc0
7742 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7743 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7744
7745sc1_http_err_cnt
7746sc2_http_err_cnt
7747 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7748 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7749 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7750
7751sc1_http_err_rate
7752sc2_http_err_rate
7753 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7754 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7755 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7756 src_http_err_rate.
7757
7758sc1_http_req_cnt
7759sc2_http_req_cnt
7760 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7761 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7762 src_http_req_cnt.
7763
7764sc1_http_req_rate
7765sc2_http_req_rate
7766 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7767 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7768 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7769 src_http_req_rate.
7770
7771sc1_inc_gpc0
7772sc2_inc_gpc0
7773 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7774 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7775 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7776 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7777 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7778 when a first ACL was verified :
7779
7780 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7781 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7782 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7783
7784sc1_kbytes_in
7785sc2_kbytes_in
7786 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7787 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7788 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7789 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7790
7791sc1_kbytes_out
7792sc2_kbytes_out
7793 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7794 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7795 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7796 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7797
7798sc1_sess_cnt
7799sc2_sess_cnt
7800 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7801 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7802 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7803 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007804 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007805 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7806
7807sc1_sess_rate
7808sc2_sess_rate
7809 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7810 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7811 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7812 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7813 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007814 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007815
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007816so_id <integer>
7817 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7818
7819src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007820 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
7821 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
7822 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007823
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007824src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007825src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007826 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7827 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7828 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007829 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007830
7831src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007832src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007833 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7834 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7835 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007836 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007837
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007838src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7839src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7840 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7841 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7842 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7843 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7844 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7845 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7846
7847 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7848 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7849 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7850 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7851 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7852 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7853 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7854
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007855src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007856src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007857 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7858 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7859 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007860 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007861
7862src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007863src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007864 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7865 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7866 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007867 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007868
7869src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007870src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007871 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7872 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7873 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007874 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007875
7876src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007877src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007878 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7879 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7880 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007881 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007882
7883src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007884src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007885 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7886 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7887 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007888 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007889
7890src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007891src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007892 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7893 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7894 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7895 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007896 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007897
7898src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007899src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007900 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7901 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7902 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007903 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007904
7905src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007906src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007907 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7908 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7909 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7910 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007911 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007912
7913src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007914src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007915 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7916 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7917 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7918 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7919 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7920 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7921
7922 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7923 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007924 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007925
7926src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007927src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007928 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7929 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7930 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7931 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007932 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007933
7934src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007935src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007936 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7937 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7938 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7939 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007940 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007941
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007942src_port <integer>
7943 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007944
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007945src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007946src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007947 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7948 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7949 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7950 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007951 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007952
7953src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007954src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007955 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7956 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7957 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7958 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007959 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007960
7961src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007962src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007963 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007964 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7965 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007966 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7967 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7968 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007969 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007970
7971 Example :
7972 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7973 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7974 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7975 listen ssh
7976 bind :22
7977 mode tcp
7978 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007979 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007980 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7981 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7982
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007983srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007984 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7985 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7986 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7987 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7988
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007989srv_id <integer>
7990 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7991
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007992srv_is_up(<server>)
7993srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7994 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7995 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7996 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7997 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7998 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7999 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8000 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8001 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8002
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008003table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008004table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008005 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8006 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8007
8008table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008009table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008010 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8011 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8012 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8013
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008014
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020080157.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8016---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008017
8018A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8019during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008020through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8021keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008022
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008023is_ssl
8024 Returns true when the incoming connection was made via an SSL/TLS data layer
8025 and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared with
8026 a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8027
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008028rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8029 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8030 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8031 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008032 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8033 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8034 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008035
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008036req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008037 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008038 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8039 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8040 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8041 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8042 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8043 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8044
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008045req_proto_http
8046 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8047 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008048 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008049 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8050 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8051
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008052req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008053req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008054 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8055 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8056 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8057 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8058 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8059 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8060 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8061 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8062
8063req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008064req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008065 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8066 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8067 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8068 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8069 cookies.
8070
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008071req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8072 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8073 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8074 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008075 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8076 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8077 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008078
8079req_ssl_sni <string>
8080 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8081 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8082 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8083 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8084 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8085 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8086 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008087 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8088 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
8089 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
8090 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008091
8092 Examples :
8093 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8094 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8095 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8096 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8097 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8098
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008099req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8100 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8101 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8102 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8103 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8104 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8105 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008106 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8107 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
8108 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
8109 option.
8110
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008111ssl_has_sni
8112 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8113 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer. Returns true
8114 when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires that
8115 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8116
8117ssl_sni <string>
8118 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8119 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8120 the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8121 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8122 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8123 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. See also ssl_sni_end
8124 and ssl_sni_req below. This requires that the SSL library is build with
8125 support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8126
8127ssl_sni_end <string>
8128 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8129 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8130 the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8131 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8132 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8133 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This requires that
8134 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8135
8136ssl_sni_req <regex>
8137 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8138 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8139 the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8140 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8141 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8142 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This requires that
8143 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008144
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008145wait_end
8146 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8147 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8148 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8149 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8150 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8151 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8152 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8153 inspection.
8154
8155 Examples :
8156 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8157 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8158 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8159
8160 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8161 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8162 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8163 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8164 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8165 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8166 tcp-request content reject
8167
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081697.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8170--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008171
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008172A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008173application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8174read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8175than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8176
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008177base <string>
8178 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8179 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8180 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8181 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8182 See also "path" and "uri".
8183
8184base_beg <string>
8185 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8186 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8187 "path_beg".
8188
8189base_dir <string>
8190 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8191 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8192 "path_dir" instead.
8193
8194base_dom <string>
8195 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8196 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8197 instead.
8198
8199base_end <string>
8200 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8201 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8202
8203base_len <integer>
8204 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8205 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8206
8207base_reg <regex>
8208 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8209 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8210 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8211 and all "base_" criteria.
8212
8213base_sub <string>
8214 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8215 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8216 also "base_dir".
8217
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008218cook(<name>) <string>
8219 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8220 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8221 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8222 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8223 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8224 sent by the server.
8225
8226 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8227 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8228 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8229
8230 cook(profile) silver gold
8231
8232cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8233 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8234 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8235 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8236
8237cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8238 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8239 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8240 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8241 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8242 server.
8243
8244cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8245 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8246 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8247 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8248 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8249 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8250
8251cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8252 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8253 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8254 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8255 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8256
8257cook_end(<name>) <string>
8258 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8259 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8260 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8261
8262cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8263 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8264 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8265 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8266 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8267 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8268
8269cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8270 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8271 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8272 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8273 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8274 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8275
8276cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8277 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8278 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8279 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8280
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008281cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8282 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8283 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8284 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8285 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8286 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8287
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008288hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008289hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008290 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8291 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8292 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8293 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008294 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8295 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8296 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8297 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8298 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008299
8300 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008301 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008302 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8303
8304 hdr(Connection) -i close
8305
8306hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008307hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008308 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8309 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8310 response headers sent by the server.
8311
8312hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008313hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008314 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8315 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8316 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8317 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8318 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8319 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8320 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8321
8322hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008323hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008324 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8325 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8326 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8327 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8328 headers sent by the server.
8329
8330hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008331hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008332 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8333 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8334 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8335 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8336 server.
8337
8338hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008339hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008340 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8341 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8342 response headers sent by the server.
8343
8344hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008345hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8346 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8347 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8348 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008349 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8350
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008351hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008352hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008353 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8354 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8355 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8356 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8357
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008358hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008359hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008360 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008361 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8362 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8363 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8364 response headers sent by the server.
8365
8366hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008367hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008368 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8369 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8370 response headers sent by the server.
8371
8372hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008373hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008374 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8375 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8376 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8377 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8378
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008379http_auth(<userlist>)
8380http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008381 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8382 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8383 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8384 of specified groups.
8385
8386 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8387
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008388http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008389 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8390 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8391 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8392 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8393
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008394method <string>
8395 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8396 already check for most common methods.
8397
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008398path <string>
8399 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8400 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8401 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8402
8403path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008404 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8405 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008406
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008407path_dir <string>
8408 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8409 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8410 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8411 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8412
8413path_dom <string>
8414 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8415 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8416 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8417
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008418path_end <string>
8419 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8420 control file name extension.
8421
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008422path_len <integer>
8423 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8424 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8425
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008426path_reg <regex>
8427 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8428 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8429 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8430
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008431path_sub <string>
8432 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8433 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8434 "path_dir".
8435
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008436payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8437 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8438 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8439 strings.
8440
8441payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8442 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8443 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8444 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8445 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8446 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8447
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008448req_ver <string>
8449 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8450 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8451
8452status <integer>
8453 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8454 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8455 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8456
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008457url <string>
8458 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008459 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008460
8461url_beg <string>
8462 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008463 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8464 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008466url_dir <string>
8467 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8468 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8469 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8470 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8471
8472url_dom <string>
8473 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8474 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8475 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8476
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008477url_end <string>
8478 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8479 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008480
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008481url_ip <address>
8482 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8483 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8484 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008485
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008486url_len <integer>
8487 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8488 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8489
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008490url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008491 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8492 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008493 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008494 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008495
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008496url_reg <regex>
8497 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8498 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008499 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008500
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008501url_sub <string>
8502 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8503 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008504
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008505urlp(<name>) <string>
8506 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8507 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8508
8509 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8510 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8511
8512urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8513 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8514 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8515 protocol scheme.
8516
8517urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8518 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8519 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8520 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8521 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8522
8523urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8524 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8525 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8526 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8527 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8528
8529urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8530 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8531
8532urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008533 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8534 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008535
8536urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8537 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8538 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8539
8540urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8541 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8542 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8543 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8544 "urlp_" criteria.
8545
8546urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
8547 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
8548 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
8549 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
8550
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02008551urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
8552 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
8553 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
8554 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
8555 negative data.
8556
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085587.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8559---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008561Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8562every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008563order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008565ACL name Equivalent to Usage
8566---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008567FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008568HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008569HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
8570HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008571HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
8572HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
8573HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
8574HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
8575LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008576METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
8577METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
8578METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
8579METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
8580METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
8581METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008582RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008583REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008584TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008585WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
8586---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008587
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085897.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
8590----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008592Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8593combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008595 - AND (implicit)
8596 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8597 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008598
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008599A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008601 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008603Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8604indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008606For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8607"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8608requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8609is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008611 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8612 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8613 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8614 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008616To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8617and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008619 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8620 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8621 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8622 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008623
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008624 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8625 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8626 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8627 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008628
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008629It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8630expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8631be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008632the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008633
8634 The following rule :
8635
8636 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8637 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8638
8639 Can also be written that way :
8640
8641 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8642
8643It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8644to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8645simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8646sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8647good use is the following :
8648
8649 With named ACLs :
8650
8651 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8652 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8653 monitor fail if site_dead
8654
8655 With anonymous ACLs :
8656
8657 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008659See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008660
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008661
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010086627.8. Pattern extraction
8663-----------------------
8664
8665The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8666response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8667for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8668
8669All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8670"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8671begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8672arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8673much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8674equivalent used in ACLs.
8675
8676The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8677
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008678 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
8679 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
8680 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
8681 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
8682 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
8683 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
8684 requested objects by host/path.
8685
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008686 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008687 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8688 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8689 according to RFC 4291.
8690
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008691 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8692 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8693 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008694 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8695 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8696 according to RFC 4291.
8697
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008698 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8699 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8700 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8701 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8702 type integer and only works with such tables.
8703
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008704 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
8705 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8706 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
8707 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
8708 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
8709 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
8710 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008711 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008712
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008713 is_ssl This checks the data layer used by incoming connection, and
8714 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS data layer,
8715 otherwise zero.
8716
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008717 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
8718 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8719 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8720 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
8721 wiser to use "url" instead.
8722
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008723 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008724 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8725 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8726 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8727 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008728
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008729 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008730 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8731 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8732 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8733 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8734 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8735 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8736 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8737 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008738
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008739 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
8740 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
8741 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
8742 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
8743
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008744 ssl_has_sni This checks the data layer used by incoming connection, and
8745 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS data layer
8746 and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
8747 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
8748 support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8749
8750 ssl_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
8751 connection made via an SSL/TLS data layer and locally deciphered
8752 by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching the HTTPS
8753 host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have been
8754 built with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8755
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008756 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
8757 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8758 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8759 keep them in caches. See also "path".
8760
8761 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
8762 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
8763 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
8764 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
8765 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
8766 table for a given source address.
8767
8768 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
8769 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
8770
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008771 url_param(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008772 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
8773 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
8774 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url
8775 (e.g. http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8776 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008777
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008778 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008779 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8780 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8781 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8782 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008783
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008784 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8785 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8786 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8787 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8788 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8789 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8790 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008791
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008792 Example :
8793 listen tse-farm
8794 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8795 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8796 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8797 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8798 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8799 persist rdp-cookie
8800 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8801 # This is only useful makes sense if
8802 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8803 stick-table type string size 204800
8804 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8805 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8806 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008807
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008808 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8809 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008810
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008811 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008812 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008813 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
8814 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
8815 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
8816 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
8817 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
8818 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008819
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008820 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008821
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008822 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008823 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
8824 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
8825 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
8826
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008827 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8828 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8829 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8830 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8831 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008832
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008833 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008834
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008835
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008836The currently available list of transformations include :
8837
8838 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8839 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8840 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8841
8842 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8843 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8844 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8845
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008846 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008847 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8848 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8849 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8850 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8851
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088538. Logging
8854----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008855
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008856One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8857provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8858very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8859provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8860state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008861to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008862headers.
8863
8864In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8865about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8866send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8867
8868 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8869 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8870 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8871 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8872 at the termination.
8873
8874The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8875allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8876as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8877while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8878real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8879delay.
8880
8881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088828.1. Log levels
8883---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008884
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008885TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008886source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008887HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8888in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8889track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8890syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8891about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008892
8893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088948.2. Log formats
8895----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008896
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008897HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008898and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8899slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8900options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008901
8902 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8903 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8904 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8905 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8906 extents.
8907
8908 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8909 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8910 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8911 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8912 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8913
8914 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8915 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8916 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8917 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8918 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8919
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008920 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8921 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8922 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8923 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8924
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008925 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
8926
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008927Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8928specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8929field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8930servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8931always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8932identifier.
8933
8934Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8935 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8936 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8937 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8938 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8939
8940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089418.2.1. Default log format
8942-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008943
8944This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8945as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8946format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8947
8948 Example :
8949 listen www
8950 mode http
8951 log global
8952 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8953
8954 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8955 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8956 (www/HTTP)
8957
8958 Field Format Extract from the example above
8959 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8960 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8961 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8962 4 'to' to
8963 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8964 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8965
8966Detailed fields description :
8967 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8968 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8969 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8970 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8971 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8972 and processed the connection.
8973 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8974
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008975In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8976"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8977connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8978
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008979It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8980will eventually disappear.
8981
8982
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089838.2.2. TCP log format
8984---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008985
8986The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8987is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8988information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8989counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8990emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8991environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8992the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8993sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008994specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8995not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8996fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8997marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008998
8999 Example :
9000 frontend fnt
9001 mode tcp
9002 option tcplog
9003 log global
9004 default_backend bck
9005
9006 backend bck
9007 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9008
9009 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9010 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9011 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9012
9013 Field Format Extract from the example above
9014 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9015 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9016 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9017 4 frontend_name fnt
9018 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9019 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9020 7 bytes_read* 212
9021 8 termination_state --
9022 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9023 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9024
9025Detailed fields description :
9026 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009027 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9028 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9029 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9030 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9031 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009032
9033 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009034 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9035 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9036 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009037
9038 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9039 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9040 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9041 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9042
9043 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9044 and processed the connection.
9045
9046 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9047 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9048 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9049 applications.
9050
9051 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9052 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9053 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9054 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9055 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9056
9057 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9058 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9059 See "Timers" below for more details.
9060
9061 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9062 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9063 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9064 "Timers" below for more details.
9065
9066 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9067 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9068 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9069 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9070 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9071 details.
9072
9073 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9074 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9075 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9076 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9077 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9078
9079 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9080 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9081 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9082 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9083 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9084 for more details.
9085
9086 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009087 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009088 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9089 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9090 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009091 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009092
9093 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9094 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9095 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9096 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9097 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9098 caused by a denial of service attack.
9099
9100 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9101 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9102 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9103 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9104 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9105 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9106 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9107 denial of service attack.
9108
9109 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9110 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9111 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9112 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9113 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9114 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9115 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9116 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9117 be processed than on other servers.
9118
9119 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9120 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9121 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9122 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9123 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9124 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9125 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9126 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9127 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9128 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9129 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9130 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9131 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9132
9133 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9134 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9135 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9136 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9137 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9138 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9139 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9140 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9141
9142 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9143 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9144 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9145 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9146 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9147 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9148 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9149 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9150 occurs.
9151
9152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091538.2.3. HTTP log format
9154----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009155
9156The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9157is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9158the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9159are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9160emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9161generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9162"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9163which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009164frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9165is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009166
9167Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9168slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9169with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9170
9171 Example :
9172 frontend http-in
9173 mode http
9174 option httplog
9175 log global
9176 default_backend bck
9177
9178 backend static
9179 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9180
9181 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9182 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9183 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009184 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009185
9186 Field Format Extract from the example above
9187 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9188 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9189 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9190 4 frontend_name http-in
9191 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9192 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9193 7 status_code 200
9194 8 bytes_read* 2750
9195 9 captured_request_cookie -
9196 10 captured_response_cookie -
9197 11 termination_state ----
9198 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9199 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9200 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9201 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9202 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009203
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009204
9205Detailed fields description :
9206 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009207 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9208 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9209 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9210 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9211 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009212
9213 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009214 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9215 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9216 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009217
9218 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9219 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9220 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9221 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9222 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9223
9224 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9225 and processed the connection.
9226
9227 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9228 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9229 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9230
9231 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9232 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9233 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9234 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9235 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9236 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9237
9238 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9239 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9240 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9241 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9242 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9243 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9244
9245 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9246 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9247 See "Timers" below for more details.
9248
9249 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9250 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9251 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9252 below for more details.
9253
9254 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9255 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9256 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9257 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9258 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9259 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9260 for more details.
9261
9262 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9263 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9264 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9265 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9266 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9267 details.
9268
9269 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9270 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9271 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9272
9273 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9274 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9275 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9276 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9277 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9278 overflowing.
9279
9280 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9281 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9282 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9283 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9284 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9285 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9286 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9287 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9288
9289 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9290 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9291 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9292 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9293 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9294 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9295 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9296 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9297
9298 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9299 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9300 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9301 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9302 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9303 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9304 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9305
9306 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009307 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009308 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9309 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9310 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009311 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009312 system.
9313
9314 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9315 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9316 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9317 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9318 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9319 caused by a denial of service attack.
9320
9321 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9322 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9323 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9324 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9325 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9326 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9327 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9328 denial of service attack.
9329
9330 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9331 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9332 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9333 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9334 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9335 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9336 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9337 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9338 processed than on other servers.
9339
9340 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9341 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9342 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9343 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9344 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9345 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9346 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9347 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9348 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9349 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9350 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9351 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9352 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9353
9354 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9355 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9356 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9357 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9358 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9359 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9360 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9361 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9362
9363 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9364 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9365 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9366 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9367 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9368 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9369 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9370 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9371 occurs.
9372
9373 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9374 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9375 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9376 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9377 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9378 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9379 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9380 cookies" below for more details.
9381
9382 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9383 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9384 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
9385 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
9386 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
9387 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
9388 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
9389 and cookies" below for more details.
9390
9391 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
9392 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
9393 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
9394 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
9395 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
9396 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
9397 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
9398 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
9399
9400
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020094018.2.4. Custom log format
9402------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009403
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009404The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
9405mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009406
9407HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
9408Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
9409separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
9410prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
9411
9412Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
9413variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
9414string formats ("Q").
9415
9416Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
9417HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
9418
9419Flags are :
9420 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009421 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009422
9423 Example:
9424
9425 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
9426 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
9427
9428At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
9429
9430 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009431 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009432
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009433the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009434
9435 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009436 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009437 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
9438
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009439and the default TCP format is defined this way :
9440
9441 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
9442 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
9443
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009444Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
9445
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009446 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9447 | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
9448 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9449 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
9450 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9451 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009452 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009453 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009454 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01009455 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009456 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
9457 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
9458 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009459 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009460 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
9461 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
9462 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009463 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
9464 | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
9465 | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009466 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009467 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
9468 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
9469 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
9470 | | %b | backend_name | string |
9471 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
9472 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
9473 | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009474 | * | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009475 | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
9476 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
9477 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
9478 | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
9479 | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
9480 | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
9481 | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
9482 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009483 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009484 | * | %r | http_request | string |
9485 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
9486 | | %s | server_name | string |
9487 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
9488 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
9489 | * | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009490 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009491 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009492 | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009493 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009494
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009495*: mode http only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009496
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094978.3. Advanced logging options
9498-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009499
9500Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
9501just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
9502options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
9503for more information about their usage.
9504
9505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
9507------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009508
9509It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
9510haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
9511commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
9512monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
9513ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
9514
9515 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
9516 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
9517 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
9518 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
9519
9520 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
9521 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
9522 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
9523 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
9524 such as other load-balancers.
9525
9526 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
9527 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
9528 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
9529
9530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095318.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
9532----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009533
9534The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
9535what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
9536or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
9537"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
9538just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
9539log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
9540after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
9541is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
9542with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
9543with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
9544
9545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095468.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
9547------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009548
9549Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
9550for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
9551"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
9552retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
9553raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
9554a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
9555file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
9556you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
9557"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
9558
9559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095608.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
9561--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009562
9563Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
9564multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
9565them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
9566"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
9567logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
9568error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
9569and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
9570too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
9571useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
9572alternative.
9573
9574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095758.4. Timing events
9576------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009577
9578Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
9579reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
9580the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
9581frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
9582mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
9583
9584 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
9585 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
9586 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
9587 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
9588 the client closes prematurely or times out.
9589
9590 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
9591 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
9592 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
9593 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
9594 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
9595
9596 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
9597 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
9598 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
9599 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
9600 connection never established.
9601
9602 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
9603 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
9604 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
9605 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
9606 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
9607 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
9608 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
9609 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
9610 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
9611 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
9612 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
9613
9614 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
9615 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
9616 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
9617 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
9618 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
9619
9620 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
9621
9622 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
9623 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
9624 negative.
9625
9626These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
9627protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
9628that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009629due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009630close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
9631session has been aborted on timeout.
9632
9633Most common cases :
9634
9635 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9636 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
9637 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
9638 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
9639 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
9640 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
9641 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
9642 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
9643 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02009644 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
9645 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
9646 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009647
9648 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9649 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
9650 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
9651 of ms on remote networks.
9652
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009653 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
9654 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
9655 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009656
9657 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
9658 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
9659 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
9660 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
9661 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
9662 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
9663 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
9664 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
9665 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
9666 to the server until another one is released.
9667
9668Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
9669
9670 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
9671 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
9672 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
9673
9674 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
9675 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
9676 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
9677
9678 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
9679 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
9680 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
9681 flags.
9682
9683 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
9684 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
9685 Check the session termination flags, then check the
9686 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
9687 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
9688 the client connection was maintained open.
9689
9690 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
9691 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
9692 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9693 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9694
9695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096968.5. Session state at disconnection
9697-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009698
9699TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9700"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
97012-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9702each of which has a special meaning :
9703
9704 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9705 session to terminate :
9706
9707 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9708
9709 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9710 server explicitly refused it.
9711
9712 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9713 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9714 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9715 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9716 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9717 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9718
9719 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9720 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9721 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9722 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9723 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9724
9725 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9726 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9727 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9728 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9729 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9730
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009731 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9732 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9733
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009734 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
9735 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
9736 backup connections when going up.
9737
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009738 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9739
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009740 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9741 send or receive data.
9742
9743 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9744 send or receive data.
9745
9746 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9747 with nothing left in the buffers.
9748
9749 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9750
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009751 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009752 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9753
9754 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9755 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9756 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9757 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9758 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
9759
9760 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
9761 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
9762
9763 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
9764 server (HTTP only).
9765
9766 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
9767
9768 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
9769 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
9770 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
9771
9772 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
9773 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
9774 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
9775
9776 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
9777
9778 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
9779 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9780
9781 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9782 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9783 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9784
9785 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9786 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009787 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9788 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009789
9790 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9791 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9792 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9793 another server.
9794
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009795 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009796 server.
9797
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009798 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9799 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9800 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9801 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9802
9803 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9804 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9805 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9806 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9807
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +02009808 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
9809 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
9810 "use-server" rule).
9811
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009812 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9813
9814 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9815 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9816
9817 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9818
9819 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9820 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9821 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9822
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009823 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9824 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9825 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9826 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9827 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9828
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009829 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9830
9831 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9832 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9833
9834 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9835
9836 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9837
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009838The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9839was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009840helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9841starvation, attacks, etc...
9842
9843The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9844alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9845easier finding and understanding.
9846
9847 Flags Reason
9848
9849 -- Normal termination.
9850
9851 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9852 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9853 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9854 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9855
9856 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9857 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9858 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9859 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9860 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9861 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009862
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009863 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9864 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009865 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009866
9867 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9868 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9869 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9870
9871 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9872 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9873 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9874 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9875 the server takes too long to respond.
9876
9877 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9878 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9879 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9880 long a time to respond.
9881
9882 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9883 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9884 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9885 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9886 and the client.
9887
9888 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9889 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9890 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9891 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9892 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9893 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9894
9895 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9896 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009897 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9898 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9899 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9900 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009902 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009903 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9904 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9905 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9906 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9907 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9908
9909 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9910 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9911 503 or 504 here.
9912
9913 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9914 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9915 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9916 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9917 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9918
9919 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9920 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009921 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009922 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9923 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9924
9925 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9926 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9927 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9928 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9929 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9930 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9931 between haproxy and the server.
9932
9933 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9934 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9935 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9936 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9937 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9938 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9939 solution is to fix the application.
9940
9941 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9942 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9943 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9944 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9945 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9946 external attacks.
9947
9948 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9949 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009950 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009951 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9952 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9953
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009954 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9955 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9956 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9957 the client.
9958
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009959 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9960 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9961 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9962 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009963 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9964 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9965 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9966 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9967 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009968
9969 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9970 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9971 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9972 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9973
9974 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9975 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9976 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9977 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9978
9979 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9980 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9981 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9982 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9983
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009984The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9985persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9986important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9987re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9988
9989 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9990
9991 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9992 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9993 set on a GET request.
9994
9995 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9996 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009997 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009998 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9999
10000 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10001 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10002 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10003
10004 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10005 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10006 already got a cookie.
10007
10008 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10009 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10010 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10011 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10012 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10013
10014 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10015 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10016 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10017
10018 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10019 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10020 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10021
10022 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10023 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10024
10025 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10026 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10027 then advertised in the response.
10028
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100308.6. Non-printable characters
10031-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010032
10033In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10034consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10035converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10036prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10037being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10038escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10039is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10040'}' when logging headers.
10041
10042Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10043issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10044containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10045
10046Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10047the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10048performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10049
10050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100518.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10052---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010053
10054Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10055achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010056section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010057cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10058the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10059the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010060locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010061not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10062user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10063a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10064wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10065
10066 Examples :
10067 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10068 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10069
10070 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10071 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10072
10073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100748.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10075---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010076
10077Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10078proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10079the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10080server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10081
10082Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10083response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010084section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010085
10086It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010087time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10088appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010089are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10090and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10091follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10092request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10093in the logs.
10094
10095 Example :
10096 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10097 listen proxy-out
10098 mode http
10099 option httplog
10100 option logasap
10101 log global
10102 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10103
10104 # log the name of the virtual server
10105 capture request header Host len 20
10106
10107 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10108 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10109
10110 # log the beginning of the referrer
10111 capture request header Referer len 20
10112
10113 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10114 capture response header Server len 20
10115
10116 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10117 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10118
10119 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10120 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10121
10122 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10123 capture response header Via len 20
10124
10125 # log the URL location during a redirection
10126 capture response header Location len 20
10127
10128 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10129 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10130 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10131 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10132 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10133
10134 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10135 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10136 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10137 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010138 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010139
10140 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10141 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10142 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10143 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10144 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010145 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010146
10147
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101488.9. Examples of logs
10149---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010150
10151These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10152them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10153reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10154
10155 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10156 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10157 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10158
10159 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10160 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10161
10162 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10163 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10164 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10165
10166 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10167 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10168
10169 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10170 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10171 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10172
10173 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010174 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010175 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10176 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10177
10178 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10179 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10180 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10181
10182 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10183 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010184 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010185 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10186 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10187 to return the 502 and not the server.
10188
10189 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010190 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010191
10192 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10193 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10194 Nothing was sent to any server.
10195
10196 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10197 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10198
10199 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10200 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10201 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10202 send a 408 return code to the client.
10203
10204 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10205 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10206
10207 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10208 5 seconds ("c----").
10209
10210 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10211 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010212 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010213
10214 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010215 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010216 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10217 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10218 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10219 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10220 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010221
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102239. Statistics and monitoring
10224----------------------------
10225
10226It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10227mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10228CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10229Unix socket.
10230
10231
102329.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010233---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010234
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010235The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10236page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10237
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010238 0. pxname: proxy name
10239 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10240 for server)
10241 2. qcur: current queued requests
10242 3. qmax: max queued requests
10243 4. scur: current sessions
10244 5. smax: max sessions
10245 6. slim: sessions limit
10246 7. stot: total sessions
10247 8. bin: bytes in
10248 9. bout: bytes out
10249 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010250 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010251 12. ereq: request errors
10252 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010253 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010254 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10255 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010256 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010257 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10258 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10259 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10260 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10261 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10262 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10263 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10264 25. qlimit: queue limit
10265 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10266 27. iid: unique proxy id
10267 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10268 29. throttle: warm up status
10269 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10270 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010271 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010272 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10273 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10274 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010275 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010276 UNK -> unknown
10277 INI -> initializing
10278 SOCKERR -> socket error
10279 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10280 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10281 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10282 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10283 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10284 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10285 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10286 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10287 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10288 disable-on-404
10289 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10290 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10291 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010292 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10293 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010294 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10295 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10296 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10297 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10298 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10299 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010300 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10301 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10302 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10303 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010304 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10305 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010306
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103089.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010309-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010310
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010311The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010312must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10313is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10314a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10315risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10316followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10317given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10318then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10319to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010320
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010321It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10322on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10323own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010324
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010325clear counters
10326 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10327 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10328 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10329 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10330 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10331
10332clear counters all
10333 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10334 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10335 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10336
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010337clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10338 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10339
10340 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10341 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10342 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10343 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10344 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10345 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10346
10347 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10348
10349 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10350 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10351 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10352 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10353 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10354 the ACLs :
10355
10356 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10357 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10358 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10359 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10360 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10361 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10362
10363 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010364 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10365 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010366
10367 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010368 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010369 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010370 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10371 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10372 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10373 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010374
10375 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10376
10377 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010378 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010379 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10380 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010381 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10382 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10383 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010384
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010385disable frontend <frontend>
10386 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
10387 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
10388 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
10389 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
10390 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
10391 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
10392 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
10393 on the stats page.
10394
10395 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10396 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10397
10398 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10399 level "admin".
10400
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010401disable server <backend>/<server>
10402 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
10403 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
10404 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
10405 during the maintenance.
10406
10407 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
10408 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
10409
10410 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010411 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010412
10413 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10414 level "admin".
10415
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010416enable frontend <frontend>
10417 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
10418 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
10419 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
10420 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
10421 which was disabled.
10422
10423 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10424 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10425
10426 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10427 level "admin".
10428
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010429enable server <backend>/<server>
10430 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
10431 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
10432
10433 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010434 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010435
10436 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10437 level "admin".
10438
10439get weight <backend>/<server>
10440 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
10441 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
10442 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
10443 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
10444 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010445 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010446
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010447help
10448 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
10449 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010450
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010451prompt
10452 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
10453 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
10454 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
10455 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
10456 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
10457 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
10458 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
10459 command.
10460
10461quit
10462 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010463
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010464set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
10465 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
10466 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
10467 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
10468 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10469 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10470 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
10471 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10472
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020010473set maxconn global <maxconn>
10474 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
10475 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
10476 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10477 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10478 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
10479 setting.
10480
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020010481set rate-limit connections global <value>
10482 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
10483 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
10484 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
10485 is passed in number of connections per second.
10486
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020010487set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
10488 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
10489 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
10490 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
10491 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
10492 IP address or affect its quality of service.
10493
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010494set timeout cli <delay>
10495 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
10496 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
10497 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
10498
10499set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
10500 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
10501 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
10502 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
10503 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
10504 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
10505 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
10506 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
10507 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
10508 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
10509 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
10510 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
10511 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
10512 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010513 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010514
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010515show errors [<iid>]
10516 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
10517 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010518 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
10519 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
10520 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010521
10522 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
10523 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
10524 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
10525 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
10526 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
10527 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
10528 are reported too.
10529
10530 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
10531 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
10532 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
10533 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
10534 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
10535 code.
10536
10537 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
10538 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
10539 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
10540 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
10541 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
10542 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
10543 line.
10544
10545 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010546 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10547 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010548 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
10549 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
10550
10551 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
10552 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
10553 00038 Location: blah\r\n
10554 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
10555 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
10556 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
10557 00204+ minal\r\n
10558 00211 \r\n
10559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010560 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010561 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
10562 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
10563 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
10564 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
10565 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
10566 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010567
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010568show info
10569 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
10570
10571show sess
10572 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010573 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
10574 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10575
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010010576show sess <id>
10577 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
10578 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10579 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
10580 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
10581 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
10582 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010583
10584show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
10585 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
10586 possible to dump only selected items :
10587 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
10588 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
10589 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
10590 for example:
10591 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
10592 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
10593 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
10594
10595 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010596 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
10597 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010598 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
10599 Release_date: 2009/09/23
10600 Nbproc: 1
10601 Process_num: 1
10602 (...)
10603
10604 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
10605 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
10606 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
10607 (...)
10608 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
10609
10610 $
10611
10612 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
10613 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
10614 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
10615 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010616 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010617
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010618show table
10619 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
10620 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
10621 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
10622 entries currently in use.
10623
10624 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010625 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010626 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
10627 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010628
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010629show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010630 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
10631 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
10632 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010633 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
10634
10635 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
10636 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
10637 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
10638 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
10639 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
10640
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010641 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10642 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10643 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10644 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10645 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10646 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10647
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010648
10649 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010650 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
10651 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010652
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010653 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010654 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010655 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010656 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10657 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10658 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10659 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010660
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010661 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010662 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010663 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10664 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010665
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010666 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
10667 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010668 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010669 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10670 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010671
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010672 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
10673 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010674 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010675 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10676 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
10677
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010678 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
10679 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
10680 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
10681 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
10682 time goes, the average event rate drops.
10683
10684 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
10685 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
10686 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010687 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
10688 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010689 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
10690 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020010691
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010692shutdown frontend <frontend>
10693 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
10694 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
10695 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
10696 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
10697 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
10698 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
10699 once it is terminated.
10700
10701 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10702 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10703
10704 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10705 level "admin".
10706
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020010707shutdown session <id>
10708 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10709 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10710 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10711 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10712 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10713 flag in the logs.
10714
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010715shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10716 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10717 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10718 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10719 'K' flag in the logs.
10720
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010721/*
10722 * Local variables:
10723 * fill-column: 79
10724 * End:
10725 */